Upload
others
View
1
Download
0
Embed Size (px)
Citation preview
Dynamic Tensile, Flexural and Fracture Tests of Anisotropic Barre Granite
by
Feng Dai
A thesis submitted in conformity with the requirements for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy
Graduate Department of Civil Engineering University of Toronto
© Copyright by Feng Dai 2010
ii
Dynamic Tensile, Flexural and Fracture Tests of Anisotropic Barre
Granite
Feng Dai
Doctor of Philosophy
Department of Civil Engineering University of Toronto
2010
ABSTRACT
Granitic rocks usually exhibit strongly anisotropy due to pre-existing microcracks induced by
long-term geological loadings. The understanding of anisotropy in mechanical properties of
rocks is critical to a variety of rock engineering applications. In this thesis, the anisotropy of
tension-related failure parameters involving tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I
fracture toughness/fracture energy of Barre granite is investigated under a wide range of loading
rates.
Three sets of dynamic experimental methodologies have been developed using the modified split
Hopkinson pressure bar system; Brazilian test to determine the tensile strength; semi-circular
bend method to determine the flexural strength; and notched semi-circular bend method to
determine the Mode-I fracture toughness and fracture energy. For all three tests, a simple quasi-
static data analysis is employed to deduce the mechanical properties; the methodology is
assessed critically against the isotropic Laurentian granite. It is shown that if dynamic force
balance is achieved in SHPB, it is reasonable to use quasi-static formulas. The dynamic force
balance is obtained by the pulse shaper technique.
iii
To study the anisotropy of these properties, rock blocks are cored and labeled using the three
principal directions of Barre granite to form six sample groups. For samples in the same
orientation group, the measured strengths/toughness shows clear loading rate dependence. More
importantly, a loading rate dependence of the strengths/toughness anisotropy of Barre granite has
been first observed: the anisotropy diminishes with the increase of loading rate.
The reason for the strengths/toughness anisotropy can be understood with reference to the
preferentially oriented microcracks sets; and the rate dependence of this anisotropy is
qualitatively explained with the microcracks interaction. Two models abstracted from
microscopic photographs are constructed to interpret the rate dependence of the fracture
toughness anisotropy in terms of the crack/microcracks interaction. The experimentally observed
rate dependence of the anisotropy is successfully reproduced.
iv
To my family
v
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
The completion of this thesis also completes my career as a student. In retrospect, the joyful days
in the University of Toronto not only opened my sights for advanced science and techniques, but
also brought numbers of friends into my life.
Foremost, I would like to express my sincerest thanks to my advisor, Professor Kaiwen Xia, for
his support, guidance and tolerance during my study at the University of Toronto. We first met in
China, while I was still lecturing courses in China and getting confused about the future. When
he decided to offer me a position to work with him as a Ph.D student in the University of
Toronto, I knew this would be a great opportunity for me to make a difference; and I cherished it
very much. So far, we have coauthored eight papers in world leading peer-review journals; and
two more in preparation. I am happy that I did not disappoint him.
Many thanks to Professor Bibu Mohanty, who had been my mentor for the passing four years.
The warmhearted advices for my future career as well as the financial supports from him are
greatly appreciated. I would also like to thank the other members in my defense committee,
Professor Evan Bentz and Professor Giovanni Grasselli and Professor Ming Cai from Laurentian
univerdity for providing valuable advices and constructive comments in improving the draft of
this thesis. Professor Murray Grabinsky in Geotechnical laboratory is appreciated for always
being nice to me.
I am grateful to Professor Qingyuan Wang and Professor Zheming Zhu in Sichuan University,
P.R.China for taking care of me before I leave for University of Toronto; Professor Lizhong
Tang from Central South University for sharing personal experience with me of working in
academia. Special thanks to Mr. Javid Iqbal, who helped me like my old brother, especially in
the first year of my doctoral program. I thank Mr. Rong Chen, Mr. Sheng Huang and Mr. Tubing
Yin for pleasant cooperation and insightful discussion during the course of this study. I am also
lucky to have been in the company of my friends and fellows in Geotechnical laboratory in the
department of Civil Engineering, Dr. M. H.B. Nasseri, Dr. Dragana Simon, Dr. Abdolreza Saebi
Moghaddam, Mr. Leonardo Trivino, Mr. Abdullah Galaa Abdelaal, Mr. Bryan Tatone, and Mr.
Omid Khajeh Mahabadi. To the technical staffs of the structure laboratory, Renzo Basset,
vi
Giovanni Buzzeo, John MacDonald, Joel Babbin, I thank you all for helping me in running my
experiments smoothly and efficiently.
I am indebted to my wife, Xiaoli Jia, for her love, encouragement, support and tolerance in the
passing four years. I would also like to thank my parents and parents-in-law who have been
always supporting me. Years ago, my father failed to enroll in the best university of China due to
the Culture Revolution; my doctoral degree awarded from a world-class university is the best
consolation to him.
The eternal love from the family fosters my strength to conquer the difficulties in rainy days,
past, present and future.
vii
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ABSTRACT................................................................................................................................... ii
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS ..........................................................................................................v
TABLE OF CONTENTS ........................................................................................................... vii
LIST OF TABLES ....................................................................................................................... xi
LIST OF FIGURES .................................................................................................................... xii
LIST OF ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS ............................................................... xxiii
LIST OF SYMBOLS .................................................................................................................xxv
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................1
1.1 Background..........................................................................................................................1
1.2 Problem Statement ...............................................................................................................5
1.3 Research Objectives.............................................................................................................6
1.4 Research Contribution .........................................................................................................7
1.5 Thesis Organization .............................................................................................................9
CHAPTER 2 LITERATURE REVIEW ...................................................................................11
2.1 Barre Granite and Its Anisotropy.......................................................................................11
2.1.1 Microstructural Investigation.................................................................................11
2.1.2 Mechanical Properties............................................................................................14
2.2 Tension Tests .....................................................................................................................20
2.2.1 Static Tension Tests ...............................................................................................20
2.2.2 Dynamic Tension Tests..........................................................................................21
2.3 Fracture Tests.....................................................................................................................23
viii
2.3.1 Static Fracture Tests...............................................................................................23
2.3.2 Dynamic Fracture Tests .........................................................................................29
CHAPTER 3 EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES ...........................................35
3.1 Samples Preparations .........................................................................................................35
3.1.1 Laurentian Granite .................................................................................................35
3.1.2 Barre Granite..........................................................................................................37
3.2 MTS Hydraulic Servo-control System...............................................................................40
3.3 Split Hopkinson Pressure Bar ............................................................................................41
3.3.1 Working Principle..................................................................................................41
3.3.2 Pulse Shaping.........................................................................................................45
3.3.3 Momentum Trap ....................................................................................................48
3.4 Laser Gap Gauge System...................................................................................................51
3.4.1 Principles and Setup...............................................................................................52
3.4.2 Calibration of the System.......................................................................................53
CHAPTER 4 DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS...........................................................................57
4.1 Background Studies ...........................................................................................................57
4.2 Dynamic Brazilian Test .....................................................................................................59
4.3 Validation of Dynamic Brazilian Test ...............................................................................61
4.3.1 Dynamic Brazilian Test without Pulse Shaping ....................................................61
4.3.2 Dynamic Brazilian Test with Careful Pulse Shaping ............................................67
4.4 Tensile Strength of Barre Granite ......................................................................................74
4.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Tensile Strength.....................................................74
4.4.2 Tensile Strength Anisotropy ..................................................................................83
4.4.3 Interpretation of the Results...................................................................................91
ix
4.5 Summary ............................................................................................................................93
CHAPTER 5 DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS..........................................................................95
5.1 Background studies............................................................................................................95
5.2 Dynamic Semi-circular Bend Flexural Test ......................................................................99
5.2.1 The Semi-circular Bend Testing in a SHPB System .............................................99
5.2.2 Determination of Flexural Strength .....................................................................100
5.3 Validation of Semi-Circular Bend Tests..........................................................................103
5.3.1 Failure Sequences of the Specimen in the Dynamic SCB Test ...........................103
5.3.2 Dynamic SCB Test without Pulse Shaping .........................................................104
5.3.3 Dynamic SCB Test with Careful Pulse Shaping..................................................107
5.4 Flexural Strength of Barre Granite ..................................................................................111
5.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Flexural Strength .................................................111
5.4.2 Flexural Strength Anisotropy...............................................................................120
5.4.3 Interpretation of the Results.................................................................................127
5.5 Summary ..........................................................................................................................133
CHAPTER 6 DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS.....................................................................135
6.1 Background Studies .........................................................................................................135
6.2 Dynamic Notched Semi-circular Bend Fracture Test ......................................................139
6.2.1 The Notched Semi-circular Bend Testing in an SHPB System...........................139
6.2.2 Determination of Mode-I Fracture Toughness ....................................................140
6.2.3 Determination of Dynamic Fracture Energy........................................................142
6.3 Validation of Dynamic Notched Semi-Circular Bend Test .............................................146
6.3.1 Dynamic Analysis and Fracture Time .................................................................146
6.3.2 Dynamic NSCB Test without Pulse Shaping.......................................................147
x
6.3.3 Dynamic NSCB Test with Careful Pulse Shaping...............................................150
6.4 Fracture Toughness Anisotropy of Barre Granite............................................................155
6.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Stress Intensity Factor .........................................155
6.4.2 Determination of Fracture Toughness of Barre Granite ......................................160
6.4.3 Fracture Toughness Anisotropy...........................................................................165
6.5 Crack-Microcrack Interaction..........................................................................................173
6.5.1 Background..........................................................................................................173
6.5.2 Microstructural Investigation and Featuring Models...........................................175
6.5.3 The Crack-Microcrack Interaction.......................................................................178
6.5.4 Finite Element Analysis of Two Models .............................................................183
6.5.5 Simulated Fracture Toughness Anisotropy..........................................................195
6.5.6 Concluding Remarks............................................................................................199
6.6 Summary ..........................................................................................................................201
CHAPTER 7 SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK ..............................................................202
7.1 Summary of the Thesis Work ..........................................................................................202
7.2 Future Work .....................................................................................................................206
7.2.1 Confining Effects .................................................................................................207
7.2.2 Thermal Effects....................................................................................................208
BIBLIOGRAPHY ......................................................................................................................211
xi
LIST OF TABLES
Table 4.1 The material properties used in the finite element model of BD samples of Barre
granite along six directions. .......................................................................................................... 82
Table 4.2 Tensile strengths of Barre granite along six directions from both static and
dynamic Brazilian tests. ................................................................................................................ 88
Table 5.1 The material properties used in the finite element model of SCB samples of Barre
granite along six directions. ........................................................................................................ 119
Table 5.2 Flexural strengths of Barre granite with corresponding loading rates as well as the
non-local reconciliation for both static and dynamic SCB tests. ................................................ 126
Table 5.3 Summary of the parameters deduced using non-local failure model for all six
sample groups of Barre granite. .................................................................................................. 130
Table 6.1 The normalized stress intensity factor aKK II πσ/* = , for an edge crack in an
infinite orthotropic strip with remote uniform traction σ............................................................ 163
Table 6.2 The material properties used in the finite element model of NSCB samples of
Barre granite along six directions. .............................................................................................. 164
Table 6.3 Fracture toughness and fracture energy of Barre granite with corresponding
loading rates from both static and dynamic NSCB fracture tests. .............................................. 172
Table 6.4 Stress intensity factor of the main crack with one collinear microcrack at different
distances to the main crack tip. ................................................................................................... 185
Table 6.5 The fracture toughness and corresponding loading rates for three models (Intact,
Model 1 and Model 2)................................................................................................................. 197
Table 6.6 The simulated Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropic index (αk) of Barre granite
with loading rates........................................................................................................................ 198
xii
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 2.1 Mineral and microcracks traced from three orthogonal planes for Barre granite;
after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008). .............................................................................................. 12
Figure 2.2 3D block diagram showing microcracks orientations in Barre granite; rose
diagrams show the alignment of microcracks and mineral fabric orientation for each plane;
reproduced after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008); the letters in the braskets are the directions used
in this thesis. ............................................................................................................................... 13
Figure 2.3 3D block diagram showing location of CCNBD specimens prepared along each
plane with respect to microcracks orientations in Barre granite (dominant fracture planes shown
in heavy exaggerated lines); reproduced after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008); the letters in the
braskets are the directions used in this thesis................................................................................ 16
Figure 2.4 Variation of fracture toughness measured along six directions with the number of
tests along each direction in Barre granite; after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008)........................... 17
Figure 2.5 Strain rate effects of the maximum compressive stress for X-, Y- and Z- samples
of Barre granite; reproduced after (Xia et al., 2008); the letters in the braskets are the directions
used in this thesis. ......................................................................................................................... 19
Figure 2.6 The three basic modes of crack propagation: (a) Mode I, opening mode; (b) Mode
II, in-plane shearing; (c) Mode III, tearing mode. ........................................................................ 24
Figure 2.7 Definition of the local coordinate axis ahead of a crack tip. Z direction is normal
to the plane. ............................................................................................................................... 25
Figure 2.8 Comparison of the fracture mechanics approach to design with the traditional
strength of material approach: (a) strength approach (b) fracture toughness approach................ 27
Figure 3.1 Procedures for preparing three types of samples: Brazilian disc (BD), semi-
circular bend (SCB) and notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) samples. ...................................... 36
xiii
Figure 3.2 3D block diagram showing longitudinal wave velocities and the sampling location
of Brazilian discs prepared along each plane with respect to microcrack orientations in Barre
granite; the first index for sample numbering represents the direction normal to the splitting
plane, and the second index indicates the propagation direction of the crack, e.g. Sample YX of
(a) BD sample; (b) SCB sample; (c) NSCB sample; the dashed lines depict the failure plane.... 39
Figure 3.3 Photoes of (a) semi-circular bend and (b) Brazilian test of rock samples in the
MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system. ............................................................................... 40
Figure 3.4 Photo of a split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system in the Department of
Civil Engineering, University of Toronto..................................................................................... 42
Figure 3.5 Schematics of a split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system and the x-t diagram
of stress waves propagation in SHPB. .......................................................................................... 43
Figure 3.6 Strain-gauge data, after signal conditioning and amplification, from a SHPB
compression test of a Barre granite sample showing the three stress waves measured as a
function of time............................................................................................................................. 44
Figure 3.7 Pulse shapers in SHPB (a) schematic of the assembly (b) unshaped and shaped
incident stress pulses..................................................................................................................... 48
Figure 3.8 The momentum-trap system: (a) the actual image and (b) the x–t diagram showing
its working principle. .................................................................................................................... 49
Figure 3.9 Comparison of stress waves from the incident bar, with and without momentum
trap; the legends refer to the stress wave with trap. ...................................................................... 51
Figure 3.10 Photo and schematics of the laser gap gauge (LGG) system set up perpendicular
to the bar axis of SHPB................................................................................................................. 53
Figure 3.11 Static calibration of the LGG system using a gap gauge blocking the collimated
beam: schematic setup and the calibration result.......................................................................... 54
Figure 3.12 Dynamic calibration of the LGG system: schematic setup and a typical dynamic
testing result compared to the predictions by Equation (3.6). ...................................................... 56
xiv
Figure 4.1 Schematic of the Brazilian test in a SHPB system. The Brazilian disc, with a
thickness B = 16 mm and diameter D= 40 mm, is sandwiched between the incident and
transmitted bars. A strain gauge is mounted on the specimen near the disc centre. ..................... 60
Figure 4.2 Dynamic forces on both ends of the Laurentian granite disc specimen tested using
a traditional SHPB without pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted. ........... 61
Figure 4.3 High-speed video images of a typical dynamic Brazilian test on Laurentian
granite without pulse shaping. ...................................................................................................... 62
Figure 4.4 Mesh of the Brazilian disc for the finite element analysis with ANSYS; P1 and P2
are the diametrical forces on both loading ends............................................................................ 64
Figure 4.5 (a) Tensile stress σx (b) compressive stress σy histories at the center of a Brazilian
disc from dynamic finite element analysis and quasi-static equation in a typical SHPB Brazilian
test on Laurentian granite without pulse shaping. ........................................................................ 65
Figure 4.6 Comparison of strain gage signal with the dynamic forces on both loading ends of
the disc in a dynamic Brazilian test on Laurentian granite using a traditional SHPB without pulse
shaping. ............................................................................................................................... 66
Figure 4.7 Dynamic forces on both ends of a Laurentian granite disc specimen tested using a
modified SHPB with careful pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted. ......... 67
Figure 4.8 High-speed video images of two typical dynamic Brazilian tests on Laurentian
granite with careful pulse shaping. ............................................................................................... 68
Figure 4.9 (a) Tensile stress σx (b) compressive stress σy histories at the center of a Brazilian
disc on Laurentian granite from both dynamic and quasi-static finite element analyses in a typical
SHPB Brazilian test with pulse shaping. ...................................................................................... 70
Figure 4.10 Comparison of the strain gage signal with the transmitted force for a dynamic
Brazilian test on Laurentian granite using a modified SHPB with careful pulse shaping............ 71
Figure 4.11 The measured tensile strength of Laurentian granite from dynamic Brazilian tests
with and without employing jaws. ................................................................................................ 73
xv
Figure 4.12 Schematics of a Brazilian test in (a) the material testing machine and (b) the
SHPB system. ............................................................................................................................... 74
Figure 4.13 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy
and (c) fxy with isotropic model, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample YX using anisotropic
model (positive for compression, negative for tension)................................................................ 76
Figure 4.14 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static
deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy with isotropic model. ........................................................ 78
Figure 4.15 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static
deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample XY, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample XZ
(positive for compression, negative for tension)........................................................................... 79
Figure 4.16 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static
deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample YX, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample YZ
(positive for compression, negative for tension)........................................................................... 80
Figure 4.17 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static
deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample ZX, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample ZY
(positive for compression, negative for tension)........................................................................... 81
Figure 4.18 Dynamic force balance check for a typical dynamic Brazilian test of Barre granite
with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted................................................. 84
Figure 4.19 Virgin Brazilian discs of Barre granite prepared for the test; each division in the
scale denotes 1 mm. ...................................................................................................................... 85
Figure 4.20 Recovered Brazilian discs of Barre granite after tests; each division in the scale
denotes 1 mm. ............................................................................................................................... 85
Figure 4.21 The variation of static tensile strength of Barre granite along six directions, i.e.
XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY, using (a) orthotropic model (b) isotropic model. ....................... 87
Figure 4.22 The variation of tensile strength with loading rates for six sample groups of Barre
granite. ............................................................................................................................... 89
xvi
Figure 4.23 The tensile strength with loading rates for samples splitting in the plane normal to
(a) X axis (b) Y axis (c) Z axis; and (d) the tensile strength anisotropic index (αt) of Barre granite
with loading rates.......................................................................................................................... 90
Figure 5.1 Schematics of the determination of the flexural strength of concrete by ASTM
standards: a) ASTM C293, i.e. center point loading; the entire load is applied at the center of the
span. The maximum tensile stress only occurs at the center of the span; b) ASTM C78, i.e. four
points loading; half of the load is applied upon each third of the span length. Maximum tensile
stress is present over the center 1/3 portion of the span. .............................................................. 97
Figure 5.2 Schematic of the semi-circular bending (SCB) testing in a SHPB system. The
semi-circular specimen, with a thickness B = 16 mm and radius R = 20 mm, is sandwiched
between the incident and transmitted bars. A strain gauge is mounted on the specimen near the
point O. ............................................................................................................................. 100
Figure 5.3 Meshing scheme of the SCB specimen for finite element analysis. F1 and F2
denote forces applied on the contact points. ............................................................................... 101
Figure 5.4 Y as a function of the dimensionless geometry parameter S/2R from the quasi-
static finite element analysis; the coefficient of determination of the fitting curve R2 is 0.9999.....
............................................................................................................................. 102
Figure 5.5 High-speed video images of a dynamic semi-circular bend test on Laurentian
granite. ............................................................................................................................. 103
Figure 5.6 Samples recovered from the SCB testing on Laurentian granite in a SHPB system
(a) without pulse shaping, and (b) with pulse shaping; each division in the scale denotes 1 mm....
............................................................................................................................. 104
Figure 5.7 Force histories on both ends of the specimen in the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian
granite without pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted. ............................ 105
Figure 5.8 Tensile stress histories at the failure spot O of the Laurentian granite specimen
from the dynamic finite element and quasi-static analyses for the SCB-SHPB test without pulse
shaping. ............................................................................................................................. 106
xvii
Figure 5.9 Strain gauge signal and the transmitted force P2 in the SCB-SHPB test on
Laurentian granite without pulse shaping. .................................................................................. 106
Figure 5.10 Demonstration of dynamic force equilibration on both ends of the specimen in the
SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite with appropriate pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.:
reflected; Tr.: transmitted............................................................................................................ 108
Figure 5.11 Tensile stress histories at the specimen failure spot from dynamic and quasi-static
finite element analyses for the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite with appropriate pulse
shaping. ............................................................................................................................. 109
Figure 5.12 Strain gauge signal and the transmitted force P2 in the SCB-SHPB test on
Laurentian granite with pulse shaping. ....................................................................................... 109
Figure 5.13 Schematics of the semi-circular bend test in (a) the material testing machine and
(b) the SHPB system................................................................................................................... 112
Figure 5.14 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation.
(a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy with isotropic model, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for ZX sample
using anisotropic model (positive for compression, negative for tension). ................................ 113
Figure 5.15 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation.
(a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy with isotropic model. .......................................................................... 115
Figure 5.16 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation.
(a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for XY sample and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for XZ sample (positive for
compression, negative for tension). ............................................................................................ 116
Figure 5.17 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation.
(a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for YX sample, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for YZ sample (positive
for compression, negative for tension)........................................................................................ 117
Figure 5.18 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation.
(a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for ZX sample, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for ZY sample using
anisotropic model (positive for compression, negative for tension)........................................... 118
xviii
Figure 5.19 Dynamic force balance check for a typical dynamic semi-circular bend test on
sample XZ of Barre granite with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.. 121
Figure 5.20 (a) Virgin semi-circular bend samples of Barre granite; (b) Recovered semi-
circular bend samples of Barre granite after tests. ...................................................................... 121
Figure 5.21 The variation of static flexural strength of Barre granite along six directions, i.e.
XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY.................................................................................................... 122
Figure 5.22 The variation of flexural strength with loading rates along six directions of Barre
granite. ............................................................................................................................. 123
Figure 5.23 The flexural strength with loading rates for samples splitting in the plane normal
to (a) X axis (b) Y axis (c) Z axis; and (d) The flexural strength anisotropic index (αf) of Barre
granite with loading rates............................................................................................................ 125
Figure 5.24 Normalized tensile stress along the prospective fracture path in a SCB XY sample;
x is the distance of a point along the prospective fracture path to the failure spot of the SCB
sample (see the insert); the fitting curve has a coefficient of determination R2 of 0.9999. ........ 128
Figure 5.25 Comparison of strengths of sample group XY of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 130
Figure 5.26 Comparison of strengths of sample group XZ of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 131
Figure 5.27 Comparison of strengths of sample group YX of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 131
Figure 5.28 Comparison of strengths of sample group YZ of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 132
Figure 5.29 Comparison of strengths of sample group ZX of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 132
Figure 5.30 Comparison of strengths of sample group ZY of Barre granite from dynamic SCB
test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model. ................................. 133
xix
Figure 6.1 Schematics of the notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) specimen in the spit
Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system with laser gap gauge (LGG) system. A strain gauge is
mounted on the specimen surface near the crack tip. ................................................................. 140
Figure 6.2 Finite element model of the NSCB specimen system (a) the half model of NSCB
sample (b) close view of the crack tip mesh (c) crack tip coordinate system............................. 141
Figure 6.3 Typical loading history and CSOD history of the NSCB specimen tested in SHPB
on Laurentian granite. ................................................................................................................. 143
Figure 6.4 Selected high speed camera images showing the fracture and fragmentation of a
NSCB Laurentian granite specimen............................................................................................ 144
Figure 6.5 Dynamic forces on both ends of the NSCB specimen tested using a conventional
SHPB on Laurentian granite. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted. .............................. 148
Figure 6.6 Comparison of CSOD and strain gage signal with the transmitted force of the
NSCB specimen tested using a conventional SHPB on Laurentian granite (the unit for CSOD is
0.05 mm). ............................................................................................................................. 149
Figure 6.7 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen tested using a conventional SHPB on
Laurentian granite with both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis. ................................. 150
Figure 6.8 Dynamic forces on both ends of the NSCB specimen tested using a modified
SHPB on Laurentian granite. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted. .............................. 151
Figure 6.9 Comparison of CSOD and strain gage signal with the transmitted force of the
NSCB specimen tested using a modified SHPB test on Laurentian granite (the unit for CSOD is
0.05 mm). ............................................................................................................................. 152
Figure 6.10 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen tested using a modified SHPB on
Laurentian granite with both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis. ................................. 153
Figure 6.11 The effect of loading rate on the fracture toughness and fracture energy of
Laurentian granite. ...................................................................................................................... 154
xx
Figure 6.12 Local coordinate system for the stress and displacement fields near the crack tip
of an orthotropic solid................................................................................................................. 156
Figure 6.13 Schematics of the straight through notched semi-circular bend fracture test in (a)
the material testing machine and (b) the SHPB system.............................................................. 161
Figure 6.14 An infinite orthotropic strip with an edge crack under remote uniform tractions
normal to the edge crack. ............................................................................................................ 161
Figure 6.15 The overall mesh of the strip and a close-view of the mesh in the vicinity of the
crack tip; the length of the trip is modeled as ten times of the width W. .................................... 162
Figure 6.16 Mesh for the NSCB specimen and crack tip local coordinate system (a) mesh of
the half model (b) close view of the crack tip mesh (c) crack tip coordinate system................. 164
Figure 6.17 Dynamic force balance check for a typical NSCB fracture test of Barre granite
with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted............................................... 165
Figure 6.18 (a) Virgin NSCB samples and (b) recovered NSCB samples of Barre granite. . 166
Figure 6.19 The variation of static fracture toughness of Barre granite on six sample groups,
i.e. XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY. ............................................................................................. 167
Figure 6.20 The variation of fracture toughness with loading rates on six directions of Barre
granite. ............................................................................................................................. 168
Figure 6.21 The variation of fracture energy with loading rates on six directions of Barre
granite. ............................................................................................................................. 169
Figure 6.22 The fracture toughness with loading rates for sample group of (a) XY, splitting in
the plane normal to X axis; (b) ZX, splitting in the plane normal to Z axis; and (c) the fracture
toughness anisotropic index αk of Barre granite. ........................................................................ 171
Figure 6.23 (a) Photo of microscopic thin section showing microcracks in a tested Barre
granite sample; Case 1: the main crack inclines at an angle of o45 to microcracks; (b) Model 1:
the crack-microcracks configuration for Case 1. ........................................................................ 176
xxi
Figure 6.24 (a) Photo of microscopic thin section showing microcracks in a tested Barre
granite sample; Case 2: The main crack is collinear to microcracks; (b) Model 2: the crack-
microcracks configuration for Case 2. ........................................................................................ 177
Figure 6.25 One arbitrarily located microcrack near the crack tip of a semi-infinite crack. . 178
Figure 6.26 The original problem and the three sub-problems decomposed from the original
one based on the superposition method. ..................................................................................... 179
Figure 6.27 The phase diagram of amplification and shielding effects of main crack due to the
presence of a unique microcrack using 0th-order and 1st-order approximate solution.............. 183
Figure 6.28 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 1; Case 1 (b) close-view of the
mesh at the vicinity of the main crack of the Intact Model. The main crack and its tip are
indicated with arrows.................................................................................................................. 186
Figure 6.29 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 1; Case 1 (b) close-view of the
mesh at the vicinity of the main crack and the inclined microcrack of Model 1; Case 1. The main
crack and its tip are indicated with arrows.................................................................................. 187
Figure 6.30 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 2; Case 2 (b) close-view of the
mesh at the vicinity of the main crack and the collinear microcrack of Model 2; Case 2. The main
crack and its tip are indicated with arrows and the collinear microcrack is also marked........... 188
Figure 6.31 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories at the vicinity of the main crack
for the semi-circular band specimen in the absence of microcracks. ......................................... 189
Figure 6.32 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories of the main crack and the
inclined microcrack of the semi-circular bend specimen in Model 1. ........................................ 190
Figure 6.33 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories of the main crack and the
collinear microcrack of the semi-circular bend specimen in Model 2........................................ 190
Figure 6.34 The dynamic load exerted on both ends of the NSCB specimen for three
configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), the load comes from an actual measurement in a
modified SHPB tests with force balance achieved on both ends of the sample. ........................ 192
xxii
Figure 6.35 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact,
Model 1 and Model 2) from both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis; force balance has
been guaranteed using a modified SHPB tests with careful pulse shaping. ............................... 193
Figure 6.36 The linear load exerted on both ends of the NSCB specimen for three
configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), assuming force balance on both loading ends of
the sample. ............................................................................................................................. 194
Figure 6.37 The evolution of the dynamic dimensionless SIFs and corresponding loading rates
of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2) with linear
dynamic loading, assuming force balance on both loading ends of the sample. ........................ 194
Figure 6.38 The simulated dynamic fracture toughness of Barre granite with loading rates for
three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2). .................................................................. 197
Figure 6.39 The simulated Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropic index (αk) of Barre granite
with loading rates based on crack-microcracks interaction model. ............................................ 199
Figure 7.1 Schematic of the Brazilian test under hydrostatic confining pressure on SHPB
system. ............................................................................................................................. 208
Figure 7.2 Schematic of the Brazilian test on SHPB system under in-situ thermal heating.209
xxiii
LIST OF ACRONYMS AND ABBREVIATIONS
1PB One Point Bend
2D Two Dimensional
3D Three Dimensional
3PB Three Point Bend
ASTM American Society for Testing and Materials
BD Brazilian Disc
CB Chevron Bend
CCNBD Cracked Chevron Notch Brazilian Disc
CCS Compact Compressive Specimens
COD Crack Opening Displacement
CSOD Crack Surface Opening Displacement
CSOV Crack Surface Opening Velocity
CSTBD Cracked Straight Through Brazilian Disc
FEA Finite Element Analysis
LORD Laser Occlusive Radius Detector
ISRM International Society of Rock Mechanics
LEFM Linear Elastic Fracture Mechanics
LVDT Linear Variable Displacement Transducers
LGG Laser Gap Gauge
SCB Semi-Circular Band
SHPB Split Hopkinson Pressure Bar
SIF Stress Intensity Factor
SR Short Rod
xxiv
TEM Transmission Electron Microscope
NSCB Notched Semi-Circular Bend
WLCT Wedge-Loaded Compact Tension
xxv
LIST OF SYMBOLS
A Cross-sectional area of the bar
Ac Area of the new generated crack surfaces
a Depth of the notch
ija Elastic compliance constants of the material
ija′ Compliance constants in the local x-y coordinate system
B The thickness of the sample
C Elastic wave velocity
c Half length of the microcrack
Cijkl Stiffness constants of Barre granite
D The diameter of the sample
d Distance of the main crack tip to the center of the microcrack
Dij Factors to determine the anisotropic fracture toughness
E Young’s Modulus
Ei Young’s Modulus in the i principle direction
fxx, fyy, fxy Dimensionless stress components for BD
F Dimensionless tensile stress component at the disc center
fc The cutoff frequency of a bar
G Shear Modulus
GC Fracture energy
Gij Shear Modulus in the i-j plane
sl Length of the striker
K Kinetic energy of the cracked fragments
k Calibrated parameter of the LGG system
xxvi
KI Mode I SIF
KIC Mode I fracture toughness
PIK Mode I propagation fracture toughness
KII Mode II SIF
KIIC Mode II fracture toughness
KIII Mode III SIF
KIIIC Mode III fracture toughness
0IK Prescripted far field loading in terms of Mode I SIF
0IIK Mode II SIF of the main crack for Intact Model
•0IK Prescribed far field loading rate
0ICK Nominal fracture toughness from measurements
1MIK Local SIF of the main crack for Model 1
•1IK Loading rate of SIF of the main crack for Model 1
2MIK Local SIF of the main crack for Model 2
•2IK Loading rate of SIF of the main crack for Model 2
LIK Local SIF of the main crack
•LIK Local loading rate of the main crack
P1 Dynamic forces on the incident end
P2 Dynamic forces on the transmitted end
Pf Failure load
qxx, qyy, qxy Dimensionless stress components for SCB
Q Dimensionless tensile stress at the failure spot
R Radius of the sample
xxvii
R0 Radius of the bar
S Distance of the two supporting pins
u Displacement vector
u&& Second time derivative of the displacement vector
u1 Displacement of the incident bar end
u2 Displacement of the transmitted bar end
X Principal axis of Barre granite with the slowest P-wave velocity
Y Principal axis of Barre granite with intermediate P-wave velocity
Z Principal axis of Barre granite with the fast P-wave velocity
V Half crack opending displacement
V0 Veloctity of the striker
W Energy carried by the stress wave
Wi Energy carried by the incident stress wave
Wr Energy carried by the reflected stress wave
Wt Energy carried by the transmitted stress wave
WG Energy consumed to create new crack surfaces
ρ Density
v Poisson’s ratio
vij Poisson’s ratio for strain in j direction by strain in i direction
εi, εr, εt Incident, reflected and transmitted strain pulse
)(tε& Strain rate
σ Tensile stress
σm Maximum tensile stress
σ0(x), τ0(x) Undisturbed normal/shear stress along the location of the microcrack
σp(x), τp(x) A pair of pseudo-tractions
σt Tensile strength
xxviii
σf Flexural strength
σt,N Tensile strength by non-local reconciliation
κ Ratio of the flexural strength to tensile strength
σ& Loading rate of the tensile stress/flexural stress
σij Stress tensor
ijε Strain tensor
σx,σy, τxy Components of the stress tensor
δ Characteristic material length
ΔU Amount of voltage reading of LGG output
ω Angular velocity
ξ Ratio of the local SIF at the main crack tip to the loading
tα Anisotropic index of tensile strength
fα Anisotropic index of flexural strength
kα Anisotropic index of Mode I fracture toughness
θ Angle of x -axis to the line linking main crack tip to the microcrack center
φ Microcrack orientation as the angle from x -axis to the 'x -axis
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 1
CHAPTER 1
INTRODUCTION
This chapter presents the background statements, thesis objectives and the organization of the
entire thesis.
1.1 Background
Under tectonic loading, rocks may naturally exhibit anisotropy with two mechanisms: 1)
anisotropic elasticity of rock forming minerals and the alignment of the grains in preferred
directions; 2) oriented pores and/or microcracks (Phillips and Phillips, 1980). It has been
reported that the alignment of microcrack in granitic rocks correlates well with the anisotropy of
physical properties, such as uniaxial compressive strength (Douglass and Voight, 1969) and
tensile strength (Peng and Johnson, 1972). Using optical techniques, Schedl et al. concluded that
the splitting planes and anisotropy in Barre granite are mainly caused by microcracks (Schedl et
al., 1986). A good correlation between microcrack density, microcrack length, microcrack sets
orientation and fracture toughness has been demonstrated recently (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008;
Nasseri et al., 2005).
Rocks are much weaker in tension than in compression. The mechanical properties resisting the
tension type failure (i.e. tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I or tension mode fracture
toughness/fracture energy) are critical to rock engineering practice such as the stability of mine
roofs, galleries, tunnel boring, cutting, crushing, drilling and blasting. By definition, tensile
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 2
strength is the rupture stress in a pure tensile uniaxial stress state. The tensile strength measured
from a bending configuration is termed flexural strength. Mode-I fracture toughness is the
critical stress intensity factor of a Mode-I (i.e. tension mode) crack. It is thus important to
characterize these tension-related properties of anisotropic rocks in general and to understand the
correlation between properties and the microcrack-induced anisotropy in particular. Barre granite
is chosen in this study because it is a well-known anisotropic granite and its microcracks
embedded structure has been well characterized (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008). In addition, it was
designated as part of a standard rock suite by the U.S. Bureau of Mines (Goldsmith et al., 1976).
Various methods have been proposed for measuring the static tensile strength and Mode-I
fracture toughness of rocks. For tensile strength measurement, direct pull test appear to the most
straightforward choice. However, given the difficulties associated with experimentation in direct
tensile tests, indirect methods serve as convenient alternatives to measure the tensile strength of
rocks; some examples are the Brazilian disc test (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978; Coviello et al.,
2005; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), the ring test (Coviello et al., 2005;
Hudson, 1969; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), and the bending test (Coviello et
al., 2005). These indirect methods aim at generating tensile stress in the sample by far-field
compression, which are much easier and cheaper in both sample preparation and experimental
instrumentation than the direct pull test.
Among these indirect methods, the Brazilian test is probably the most popular one due to its
superior features like convenient specimen preparation and easy experimentation. It has been
suggested by the International Society for Rock Mechanics (ISRM) as a recommended method
for measuring the tensile strength of rocks (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978). For anisotropic rocks,
many researchers have investigated the tensile strength mostly using Brazilian tests, such as
Berenbaum and Brodie on coals (Berenbaum and Brodie, 1959), Evans on coals (Evans, 1961),
Hobbs on siltstones, sandstones and mudstones (Hobbs, 1964), Mclamore and Gray on shales
(Mclamore and Gray, 1967) and Barla on gneisses and schists (Barla, 1974), Chen et al. on four
types of bedded sandstones (Chen et al., 1998a) and Dai et al. on Barre granite (Dai and Xia,
2010).
Another indirect method is the bending test. Bending of one dimensional specimens (i.e. beams
with circular or rectangular cross section) is very popular in many branches of civil engineering
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 3
(Coviello et al., 2005). Three points bending (3PB) and four points bending (4PB) tests are even
adopted as a standard for determining the flexural strength of materials such as natural and
artificial building stones, rocks, cement and concrete (ASTM C99 / C99M-09, 2009; ASTM
C880 / C880M-09, 2009; ASTM Standard C78-09, 2009; ASTM Standard C293-07, 2007; BS
EN 12372, 1999; BS EN 13161, 2008). The measured tensile strength from bending tests, or
flexural strength is generally higher than the tensile strength measured from direct pull or
Brazilian tests (Coviello et al., 2005). Since rocks are usually obtained in the form of rocks cores,
it is thus convenient to use core-based specimens. A semi-circular bend technique is thus
developed in this work to measure the flexural strength of rocks, featuring core-based sample
geometry and bending loading configuration.
To measure Mode-I fracture toughness of rocks, myriads of techniques have also been
documented in the literature, methods including radial cracked ring (Shiryaev and Kotkis, 1982),
notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) (Chong and Kuruppu, 1984; Lim et al., 1994a; Lim et al.,
1994b; Lim et al., 1994c), chevron-notched SCB (Kuruppu, 1997), Brazilian disc (Guo et al.,
1993), and cracked straight through Brazilian disk (CSTBD) (Atkinson et al., 1982; Chen et al.,
1998b; Fowell and Xu, 1994). International Society of Rock Mechanics (ISRM) also proposed
short rod (SR) and chevron bending (CB) tests in 1988 (Ouchterlony, 1988) and cracked chevron
notched Brazilian disc (CCNBD) in 1995 (Fowell et al., 1995). All of those specimens are core-
based, which facilitate sample preparation obtained directly from cores of natural rock masses.
For anisotropic rocks, Kirby and Mazur investigated the fracture toughness on coal and studied
the effects of anisotropic nature of coal to the fracture toughness both experimentally and
analytically (Kirby and Mazur, 1985). Chen and his coworkers determined the mixed-mode (I–II)
fracture toughness of a shale with CSTBD tests (Chen et al., 1998b) and an anisotropic Hualien
marble using the cracked ring test (Chen et al., 2008) and CSTBD tests (Ke et al., 2008). Nasseri
and Mohanty measured fracture toughness of four types of granite with CCNBD (Nasseri and
Mohanty, 2008; Nasseri et al., 2005; Nasseri et al., 2006).
In many mining and civil engineering applications, such as quarrying, rock cutting, drilling,
tunneling, rock blasts, and rock bursts, rocks are stressed dynamically. Accurate
characterizations of rock mechanical properties over a wide range of loading rates are thus
crucial. Researchers also have extended the static method to the regime of dynamic testing. For
the dynamic tensile strength measurement, Zhao and Li (2000) measured the dynamic tensile
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 4
properties of granite with the Brazilian tests, with the loading driven by air and oil. To attain
tensile strength of rocks under higher loading rates, a Brazilian test is adopted in the standard
dynamic testing device, the split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB). For examples, conventional
SHPB tests were conducted on Brazilian discs of marble (Wang et al., 2006; Wang et al., 2009)
and argillite (Cai et al., 2007) to measure the dynamic tensile strengths. Quasi-static analysis had
been used in these works to relate far-field peak load to the tensile strength of the sample but
without sufficient justification. For Mode-I fracture toughness measurement, Tang tried to
measure dynamic fracture toughness of rocks by three point impact using a single Hopkinson bar
(Tang and Xu, 1990), and Zhang employed the SHPB technique to measure the rock dynamic
fracture toughness with short rod (SR) specimen (Zhang et al., 2000; Zhang et al., 1999). In these
attempts with Hopkinson bar, the evolution of the stress intensity factor (SIF) and the fracture
toughness were calculated using quasi-static analysis without careful consideration of the loading
inertial effects; this will lead to significant errors of the measurements.
The SHPB technique is increasingly becoming the standard method of measuring material
dynamic mechanical properties in the strain rate range 102~104 s-1 for a variety of engineering
materials, such as metals (Gray, 2000), composites (Ninan et al., 2001), concrete (Ross et al.,
1996; Ross et al., 1995), ceramics (Chen and Ravichandran, 2000; Chen and Ravichandran, 1996;
Chen and Ravichandran, 1997), and rocks (Dai et al., 2010c; Dai and Xia, 2010; Shan et al.,
2000; Xia et al., 2008; Zhang et al., 2000; Zhang et al., 1999). Recently, novel techniques in
SHPB tests have emerged. The pulse-shaper technique eliminates the high frequency oscillations
of the stress waves in the dynamic tests, resulting in a smooth loading pulse and a significant
improvement in the interpretation of the dynamic response (Frew et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002).
It is especially useful for investigating dynamic response of brittle materials such as rocks (Frew
et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002). The momentum-trap technique in SHPB (Song and Chen, 2004)
can prohibit multiple loading due to the reflection of the stress waves, thus is best suited for
quantitatively assessing the loading wave induced damage to the sample. With these newly
developed techniques in SHPB, the tensile, flexural and fracture tests can be accommodated on
the SHPB system to characterize the corresponding mechanical properties of brittle rocks.
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 5
1.2 Problem Statement
Preferentially oriented microcracks in Barre granite are thought to be responsible for the
anisotropic behavior of physical/mechanical properties. It is of interest to characterize the
mechanical properties of Barre granite in general and to understand the correlation between
mechanical properties and the microcrack-induced anisotropy in particular. Researches on some
static physical/mechanical properties of anisotropic Barre granite have been reported. However,
dynamic tests on the Barre granite are rarely investigated in the literature.
Early dynamic compression and tension tests were conducted on Barre granite to investigate the
loading rate effect and the correlation between the micro-structure induced anisotropy and
material mechanical properties (Goldsmith et al., 1976). However, as pointed out by Xia et al.
(2008), the effect of micro-structures on the dynamic behavior of Barre granite was inconclusive
due to lack of control of the loading rate and other deficiencies in the experimental design. For
instance, the pulse-shaper technique (Frew et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002) is especially useful to
modify the loading pulse and thus facilitate dynamic stress equilibrium for quasi-static stress-
strain analysis in compression tests. In addition, through a careful design of the geometry of the
pulse-shaper, the resulting loading rate or strain rate can be a constant. It is thus necessary to
revisit the tension tests on Barre granite in a systematic manner with newly developed techniques
in SHPB tests. For the dynamic flexural tests and the Mode-I fracture tests of Barre granite, these
has never been attempted in the literature.
Dynamic tension, flexural and fracture tests of rocks are much harder to carry out than their
static counterparts. In contrast to the static tests, there are no ISRM suggested methods for the
dynamic testing of rocks. On the other hand, the extent of anisotropy of some mechanical
properties of Barre granite could be subtle. A delicate and systematic dynamic testing method is
thus urgent. In this thesis, a set of dynamic rock tension, flexural and fracture testing methods are
proposed based on core-based rock samples using SHPB. These methods are then critically
assessed before they are applied to characterizing the anisotropy of Barre in tension, bending and
fracture.
This thesis builds on previous investigation on the effect of microcrack-induced anisotropy of
dynamic compressive strength (Xia et al., 2008) to further investigate the anisotropy of tension,
flexural and fracture properties: tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 6
toughness/fracture energy of Barre granite under a wide range of loading rates as well as their
relationship to the embedded microcracks preferentially oriented in the granite. The validity of
proposed testing methods in SHPB is carefully checked with the aid of high speed photography.
The tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropy and their micro-
structural correlations are investigated.
1.3 Research Objectives
The ultimate research objectives of this thesis are 1) to quantify the anisotropy of tension-related
failure parameters, including the tensile strength, the flexural strength and the Mode-I fracture
toughness/fracture energy of anisotropic Barre granite over a wide range of loading rates and 2)
to establish the relationship between the preferentially oriented microcrack sets in granitic rocks
and the anisotropy of these properties.
To achieve so, four sub-objectives have to be addressed in turn.
• First, to accurately characterize the tensile strength, the flexural strength and the Mode-I
fracture toughness/fracture energy of rocks; systematic testing methods in conjunction with
data reduction have to be developed. Three sets of dynamic testing methodologies
involving experimentation and calculation equations using the standard dynamic testing
machine (i.e. SHPB) will be proposed to measure these properties.
• Second, the reliability and robustness of the proposed dynamic testing methodologies for
measuring dynamic tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness
should be rigorously validated.
• Third, the dynamic tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness of
Barre granite are to be investigated with respect to six directions under a wide range of
loading rates. The correlation between the preferred oriented microcrack sets in the Barre
granite and the apparent anisotropy of these mechanical properties will be established.
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 7
• Last, the degree of anisotropy for all three parameters appears to be rate dependent: it
diminishes with the dynamic loading rate. Qualitative interpretations are to be given on the
loading rate dependence of the apparent mechanical properties anisotropy. Specifically,
two representative models from two microscopic photos of recovered samples are used to
explain the observed rate dependence of the anisotropy of fracture toughness in the
theoretical framework of crack-microcrack interaction.
1.4 Research Contribution
1.Examined the dynamic Brazilian tests using split Hopkinson pressure bar for measuring the
dynamic tensile strength of rocks. It has been proved that the dynamic Brazilian test is valid,
provided dynamic force balance has been achieved on both ends of the Brailian disc. The
discussion has been published in the journal of Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineerings:
• Dai, F., Huang, S., Xia, K. and Tan, Z., 2010. Some fundamental issues in dynamic
compression and tension tests of rocks using split Hopkinson pressure bar. Rock
Mechanics and Rock Engineering, doi: 10.1007/s00603-010-0091-8.
2.The evaluated dynamic Brazilian testing methods are then used to investigate the tensile
strength anisotropy of Barre granite under a wide range of loading rates. This work has been
summerized in the journal of Pure and Applied Geophysics:
• Dai, F. and Xia, K., 2010. Loading Rate Dependence of Tensile strength anisotropy of
Barre granite. Pure and Applied Geophysics, doi: 10.1007/s00024-010-0103-3.
3.Proposed and evaluated the dynamic semi-circular Bend method using split Hopkinson
pressure bar for measuring the dynamic flexural strength of rocks. The method evaluation has
been detailed in the journal of Review of Scientific Instruments; the rate dependence of the
flexural strength of a granite has been reported in the jouranl of International Journal of Rock
Mechanics and Mining Sciences, as shown below.
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 8
• Dai, F., Xia, K. and Luo, S.N., 2008. Semicircular bend testing with split Hopkinson
pressure bar for measuring dynamic tensile strength of brittle solids. Review of Scientific
Instruments, 79(12).
• Dai, F., Xia, K.W. and Tang, L.Z., 2010. Rate dependence of the flexural tensile strength
of Laurentian granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 47(3):
469-475.
• The invesigation of the flexural strength anisotropy of the anisotropic Barre granite has
also been reported in this thesis and a draft on this topic will soon be submitted to a jouranl.
4 . Proposed and evaluated the dynamic notched semi-circular Bend method using split
Hopkinson pressure bar for measuring the dynamic Mode-I fracture toughness of rocks. The
method evaluation has been published in the journal of Experimental Mechanics; Using a laser
gap gauge (LGG) developed by Chen, R., the author explored the method of using the same
notched semi-circular bend to measure the fracture energy of rocks. The collaboration on this
work ends up with a co-authored paper published in the journal of Engineering Fracture
Mechanics, as listed below.
• Dai, F., Chen, R. and Xia, K., 2010. A semi-circular bend technique for determining
dynamic fracture toughness. Experimental Mechanics, doi:10.1007/s11340-009-9273-2.
• Chen, R., Xia, K., Dai, F., Lu, F. and Luo, S.N., 2009. Determination of dynamic fracture
parameters using a semi-circular bend technique in split Hopkinson pressure bar testing.
Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 76(9): 1268-1276.
• The invesigation of the Mode-I fracture toughness and fracture energy of the anisotropic
Barre granite has also been investigated in this thesis and a draft on this topic is under
preparation, to be submitted to a journal.
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 9
1.5 Thesis Organization
This thesis comprises seven chapters. The key contents for each chapter are outlined below.
Chapter 1: This chapter presents the background statements, thesis objectives and the
organization of the entire thesis.
Chapter 2: A review of the existing research on the microscopic characterization of the
microstructure of Barre granite, as well as investigation of its mechanical properties is covered.
The methodology for rock tension and fracture tests under both static and dynamic loadings are
reviewed in details. Attention is paid on the dynamic tension and fracture tests of rocks using the
split Hopkinson pressure bar.
Chapter 3: The experimental setup and the working principles are presented, along with
procedures of sample preparations for tension, flexural and fracture tests. Novel techniques in the
split Hopkinson pressure bar, including pulse shaping technique, momentum trap technique and
laser gap gauge system are discussed.
Chapter 4: In this chapter, a Brazilian disc testing method is proposed to measure the
dynamic tensile strength of rocks. Both traditional and pulse shaped split Hopkinson pressure bar
tests are conducted to validate the dynamic Brazilian tests method with isotropic granite
Laurentian granite for demonstration. This method is then applied to investigate tensile strength
of anisotropic Barre granite along six directions. The rate dependence of the tensile strength
anisotropy has been observed and the correlation to the microstructure of Barre granite has been
stated.
Chapter 5: In this chapter, a semi-circular bend flexural testing method is proposed to
measure the dynamic flexural strength of rocks with split Hopkinson pressure bar system. To
validate the dynamic flexural testing method, both traditional and pulse shaped split Hopkinson
pressure bar tests are conducted on isotropic Laurentian granite; and the data reduction method is
critically assessed. This method is then adopted to investigate the loading rate dependence of
flexural strength anisotropy of Barre granite. The result is then interpreted. The flexural strength
is consistently higher than the tensile strength by Brazilian test for all directions; and this has
been interpreted with a non-local failure approach.
CHAPTER 1: INTRODUCTION 10
Chapter 6: In this chapter, a notched semi-circular bend testing method is proposed to
measure the dynamic Mode-I fracture toughness and fracture energy of rocks; and this novel
method is critically assessed using isotropic Laurentian granite. This method is then applied to
investigating the loading rate dependence of Mode-I fracture properties of anisotropic Barre
granite. The rate dependence of the fracture toughness anisotropy is observed and two conceptual
models abstracted from microscopic thin section photos are constructed to qualitatively
reproduce the rate dependence of the fracture toughness anisotropy in terms of the interaction of
the main crack with pre-existing microcracks preferred oriented along different directions of
Barre granite.
Chapter 7: This chapter summarizes the overall conclusions of the thesis from the preceding
chapters. Future work has also been outlined.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 11
CHAPTER 2
LITERATURE REVIEW
A review of the existing research on microscopic characterization of microstructure of Barre
granite, as well as investigation of its mechanical properties is covered. The methodology for
rock tension and fracture tests under both static and dynamic loadings are reviewed in details.
Attention is paid to the dynamic tension and fracture tests of rocks using the split Hopkinson
pressure bar.
2.1 Barre Granite and Its Anisotropy
2.1.1 Microstructural Investigation
Barre granite, the rock chosen for current study in this thesis is obtained from the same source as
that reported by Nasseri and Mohanty (2008). By virtue of recent development of computer-
aided image analysis programs, it is feasible to characterize the microstructure of rocks through
analysis of digital images obtained from thin sections (Launeau and Robin, 1996; Nasseri et al.,
2005).
As shown in 4Figure 2.1, three thin sections are sliced along three orthogonal planes normal to the
three axes along which P-wave velocities were measured. Intermediate, fast and slow directions
were assigned X, Y, and Z axes, respectively (see 4Figure 2.2 also). The mineral and microcracks
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 12
can thus be optically traced. The microcracks are of either the intragranular or intergranular type
and are found in quartz and feldspar grains, and along cleavage planes of biotite grains (Nasseri
and Mohanty, 2008).
Figure 2.1 Mineral and microcracks traced from three orthogonal planes for Barre granite;
after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008).
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 13
Figure 2.2 3D block diagram showing microcracks orientations in Barre granite; rose diagrams show the alignment of microcracks and mineral fabric orientation for each plane; reproduced after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008); the letters in the braskets are the directions used in this thesis.
In the YZ plane, microcracks are preferably oriented with an average length of 1.07 mm and
maximum length of 3.5 mm cutting through the larger quartz grains. The 3D block diagram of
microcracks orientation in 4Figure 2.2 reveals the larger microcracks (2~3 mm long) are evident
to run parallel to the Y-axis while the shorter ones (~1 mm) run parallel to the Z-axis. Mineral
fabric orientation is aligned with the direction of longer microcrack orientation with a minimal
angular disagreement of 3˚ with respect to the Y-axis in that plane, and the former yields a shape
ratio of 1.25.
In the XY plane, the intermediate size microcracks (~2 mm) are oriented parallel to the Y-axis
and the shorter ones are again parallel to the X-axis in this plane. The mineral fabric orientation
follows the longer microcrack preferred orientation direction and the former reveal a shape ratio
of 1.25 in that plane.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 14
In the XZ plane, the longer microcracks are aligned sub-parallel to the X-axis, whereas the
smaller microcracks are found to be nearly parallel to the Z-axis. The mineral fabric direction
follows a similar trend as that of preferred microcrack, and shows a mineral shape ratio of 1.07
along the XZ plane. The rose diagram representing the microcrack orientations and length along
specific direction for each plane is shown in 4Figure 2.2.
Douglass and Voight (1969) had pointed out that the microcracks in Barre granite are
preferentially oriented and there is a strong concentration of microcracks within the rift plane
(plane of easiest splitting) and the secondary concentration was found within the grain plane.
According to Freleigh Fitz Osborne (1935), the rift, grain, and hardway are planes approximately
at right angles to one another along which granites fail most easily under tension. The rift is due
to the peculiar properties of quartz and is approximately horizontal in granites. The grain is in the
direction of foliation. The hardway may be a direction at right angles to the other two or may be
determined by tectonic cracks or other features. With reference to the dominant three sets of
microcracks in 4Figure 2.3, it can be concluded that 1) XY plane (normal to the Z axis with the
slowest P-wave velocity) is recognized to be parallel to the rift plane with the dominant
microcracks; 2) YZ plane (normal to the X axis with the intermedial P-wave velocity) is parallel
with the sub-dominant microcrack second set (grain plane) and 3) the least dominant third set
(hard way or most resistive plane) runs parallel with the XZ plane (normal to the Y axis with the
fast P-wave velocity) in Barre granite (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008). The XY plane, YZ plane
and XZ plane correspond to the quarryman’s description of “rift plane”, “grain plane” and “hard-
way plane” respectively.
2.1.2 Mechanical Properties
The mechanical properties of Barre granite had been investigated by many scholars, mostly on
static behaviors. For examples, Riley and Brace considered the influence of the confining
pressure on the static compressive strength of Barre granite; no consideration has been given to
its anisotropy (Riley and Brace, 1971). Hardy and Jayaraman (1970) measured the static tensile
strength along three orthogonal directions. The strength yields negligible difference in two
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 15
orthogonal directions, but drastically different from the third axis, indicating a transversely
isotropic of Barre granite regarding its tensile strength. For fracture toughness measurement,
Iqbal and Mohanty compared the measured toughness of Barre granite with three methods: the
chevron bend (CB) test, the short rod (SR) test and the cracked chevron notch Brazilian disc
(CCNBD) test (Iqbal and Mohanty, 2007). The main purpose of their research is to assess the
ISRM proposed three standard methods, the microcracks induced anisotropy has not been taken
into account (Iqbal and Mohanty, 2007).
After the “rift plane” and the “hard plane” are identified with respect to the three orthogonal axis
sorted with P-wave velocities, Nasseri and Mohanty (2008) measured fracture toughness of
Barre granite with cracked chevron notched Brazilian disc (CCNBD) (Fowell et al., 1995)
prepared along six different directions. 4Figure 2.3 illustrates the 3D block diagram showing
location of CCNBD specimens prepared along each plane with respect to microcracks
orientations in Barre granite. The dominant fracture planes are shown in heavy exaggerated lines
so that the “rift plane” is explicitly visualized. The sample is named XY if it fractures in the
plane normal to X axis and the fracture propagates along Y axis.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 16
Figure 2.3 3D block diagram showing location of CCNBD specimens prepared along each plane with respect to microcracks orientations in Barre granite (dominant fracture planes shown in heavy exaggerated lines); reproduced after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008); the letters in the braskets are the directions used in this thesis.
4Figure 2.4 shows the variation of the measured fracture toughness along six directions with the
number of tests along each direction in Barre granite. It is evident that sample ZY yields the least
fracture toughness while sample YX yields the highest. Referring to the identification of the “rift
plane” and the “hard plane”, it is easy to interpret the result. Sample ZY fractures within the
plane normal to Z axis, i.e. the rift plane, and it is thus easier to be broken, leading to the lowest
fracture toughness. In contrast, the plane normal to Y axis is the hardest to split, thus sample YX
split in plane normal to Y axis yields the highest fracture toughness.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 17
Figure 2.4 Variation of fracture toughness measured along six directions with the number of tests along each direction in Barre granite; after (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008).
Goldsmith et al. (1976) conducted quasi-static tension and compression experiments on an
Instron testing machine and dynamic direct tension and compression tests on a split Hopkinson
bar. In the notation of this work, they used orientation 2 (maximum static Young’s modulus),
orientation 3 (minimum static Young’s modulus), and orientation 1 (intermediate Young’s
modulus) to denote the three orthogonal planes in Barre granite. With respect to the P-wave
velocity, orientation 1 corresponds to the direction with the intermediate P-wave velocity;
orientation 2 corresponds to the direction with the maximum P-wave velocity; orientation 3
corresponds to the direction with the minimum P-wave velocity. Thus, it is easier to identify that
the “rift plane” corresponds to the plane normal to the orientation 3; the “grain plane”
corresponds to the plane normal to the orientation 1; and “hard-way plane” corresponds to the
plane normal to the orientation 2.
Goldsmith et al. (1976) showed that (a) direction 2 has the highest tensile strength and (b) the
tensile strength for each direction has clear rate dependence. With reference to 4Figure 2.3,
because most of the microcracks are parallel with orientation 2, the plane normal to orientation 2
is the “hard-way plane”. It is thus expected that the tensile strength is the highest in direction 2 as
shown by Goldsmith et al. (1976). On the other hand, microcracks are mostly perpendicular to
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 18
the orientation 3 (with the minimum P-wave velocity), and thus facilitate opening and linking of
themselves in the direct pull test. The measured tensile strength in direction 3 thus should be the
lowest.
Xia et al. (2008) revisited the dynamic compression tests of Barre granite with SHPB, the effects
of microcrack induced anisotropy on the dynamic response of Barre granite are investigated. The
recently developed techniques in the last a couple of years have been employed in the SHPB
tests. They are pulse shaper technique (Frew et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002) for achieving stress
equilibrium and momentum trap technique (Nemat-Nasser et al., 1991) for ensuring single
loading pulse for soft recovery of samples. The axial directions of the samples are chosen to be
parallel to the preferred direction of microcracks and the samples are grouped and denoted by Y
(lowest P wave velocity), Z (highest P wave velocity), and X (intermediate P wave velocity).
The results are re-plotted in 4Figure 2.5. It is noted that σm in 4Figure 2.5 designates the maximum
stress achieved during the tests; it is not equivalent to the compressive strength because some
samples tested at low strain rate (~70/s) remained intact after the test. For samples cracked and
fragmented, σm can be taken as dynamic compressive strength. It is shown from 4Figure 2.5 that
for all three sample groups, they have obtained the compressive strength under strain rate ~100/s.
Since the strain rate is constant, they can thus examine the strengths with respect to principal
directions, excluding the rate effects of the strength. Y samples have the highest measured
compressive strength; while the X and Z samples are much less.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 19
Figure 2.5 Strain rate effects of the maximum compressive stress for X-, Y- and Z- samples of Barre granite; reproduced after (Xia et al., 2008); the letters in the braskets are the directions used in this thesis.
The Y axis of the Barre granite block by Xia et al.(2008) is the direction with the lowest P wave
velocity, corresponding to the Z axis in the notation by Nasseri and Mohanty (2008), which
certainly has the lowest P-wave velocity; and the rift plane is normal to this axis. Previous
investigations on the compressive tests of brittle rocks have generally agreed that all the rock
samples failed along macroscopic fractures, which is formed by the growth and coalescence of
microcracks oriented parallel to the maximum compressive stress (Ashby and Sammis, 1990;
Horii and Nemat-Nasser, 1986; Rawling et al., 2002). The rift plane essentially has the most
microcracks, which are oriented perpendicular to the loading direction of Y sample. The
compression in Y direction of Barre granite causes the majority of the microcracks to close
rather than open. It is thus much harder to fail the sample in this direction, resulting in the
highest measured compressive strength. In the other two directions, microcracks in the rift plane
(together with other microcracks sets) contribute to failing of the sample, yielding a lower
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 20
compressive strength (4Figure 2.5). This mechanism explains why Y samples have higher strength
than X and Z samples.
2.2 Tension Tests
2.2.1 Static Tension Tests
Like all other brittle solids, rocks are considerably weaker in tension than in compression.
Understanding of tensile strength of rocks and other brittle materials thus bears important
engineering and geophysical applications, such as quarrying, rock drilling, cutting, rock blasting
and rockbursts.
Various methods have been proposed for measuring the tensile strength of rocks. Direct tensile
or pull test is a natural approach to measuring the tensile strength of brittle solids and
International Society for Rock Mechanics (ISRM) has suggested a method for determining direct
tensile strength of rocks (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978). However, the stress concentration due
to the sample gripping often induces damage near sample ends, causing premature failure and
deviation from the desired uniaxial stress state. In addition, bending in direct tensile tests due to
imperfections in the sample preparation and misalignment makes it difficult to interpret the
testing results (Coviello et al., 2005).
Given the difficulties associated with experimentation with direct tensile tests, indirect methods
serve as convenient alternatives to measure the tensile strength of rocks; some examples are the
Brazilian disc test (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978; Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson et al., 1972;
Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), the ring test (Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson, 1969; Hudson et al.,
1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), and the bending test (Coviello et al., 2005). These indirect
methods aim at generating tensile stress in the sample by far-field compression, which are much
easier and cheaper in both sample preparation and experimental instrumentation than the direct
pull test. Among these indirect methods, the diametrical compression of thin disc specimen is
probably the most popular one due to advantages of convenient specimen preparation and
experimental implementation. This method is termed the Brazilian test, because a Brazilian
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 21
engineer Fernando L.L.B. Carneriro first developed and presented this method of measuring the
tensile strength of concrete under quasi-static loading in 1943 at the fifth meeting of the
Brazilian association for technical rules. It has also been suggested by the International Society
for Rock Mechanics (ISRM) as a recommended method for tensile strength measurement of
rocks (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978). The Brazilian test has been chosen by many researchers
to measure the indirect tensile strength of rocks and investigate the effect of anisotropy on the
tensile strength. Examples are Berenbaum and Brodie (1959) on coals, Evans (1961) on coals,
Hobbs (1964) on siltstones, sandstones and mudstones, Mclamore and Gray (1967) on shales and
Barla (1974) on gneisses and schists, and Chen et al. (1998a) on four types of bedded sandstones.
2.2.2 Dynamic Tension Tests
Existing attempts to measure rock tensile strength are mostly limited to quasi-static loading,
primarily due to the difficulties in experimentation and subsequent data interpretation for
dynamic tests. However, in many mining and civil engineering applications, such as quarrying,
rock cutting, tunneling, rock blasts, and rockbursts, rocks are stressed and failed dynamically.
Accurate measurement of dynamic tensile strength is thus critical. Direct dynamic tensile testing
is rare (Goldsmith et al., 1976), and existing research efforts have concentrated on extending the
indirect methods from quasi-static to dynamic loading.
Researchers first tried to modify the material testing machine to achieve fast loading. For
example, Zhao and Li (2000) measured the dynamic tensile properties of Bukit Timah granite
from Singapore with the Brazilian disk and three point bending flexural methods using a self-
designed fast-loading material testing machine. The tensile strengths obtained by both methods
increase as the loading rate increases. It was also observed that the flexural tensile strength
determined by the 3-point flexural method is about 2.5 times of the tensile strength determined
by the Brazilian method at the same loading rate, but the reason for it was not given.
It has been generally recognized that the tensile strength of rocks is loading rate dependent. To
characterize the tensile strength under higher loading rates, most researchers tried to use the
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 22
popular dynamic testing facility, split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) to achieve wider range of
dynamic loading. The SHPB is increasingly becoming a standard dynamic testing machine for
measuring dynamic mechanical properties in the high loading range for a variety of engineering
materials, such as metals (Gray, 2000), composites (Ninan et al., 2001), concretes (Ross et al.,
1996; Ross et al., 1995), ceramics (Chen and Ravichandran, 2000; Chen and Ravichandran, 1996;
Chen and Ravichandran, 1997) and rocks (Xia et al., 2008; Zhang et al., 2000; Zhang et al.,
1999). SHPB has also been adopted to conduct indirect tension tests for measuring the tensile
strength of brittle solids like rocks. Core-based samples have also received wide popularity in
dynamic tests. The Brazilian disk test technique was recently implemented in a two-bar
Hopkinson type loading technique. Tedesco et al. perhaps were the first to perform a Brazilian
test in a Hopkinson bar setup (Hughes et al., 1993; Tedesco et al., 1994; Tedesco and Ross, 1998;
Tedesco et al., 1989; Tedesco et al., 1991). They used this loading technique to measure the
dynamic tensile strength of concrete at the strain rate range of 1 s-1~8 s-1 (Tedesco et al., 1989).
So far an increasing number of researchers have employed a Brazilian disk in Hopkinson bar
compression tests for measuring the dynamic tensile strength of ceramic materials (Johnston and
Ruiz, 1995; Rodriguez et al., 1994), concretes (Ross et al., 1995; Ross et al., 1989) and mortars
(Ross et al., 1989), and an explosive stimulant (Grantham et al., 2004).
For rocks, spalling tests were performed on rocks from three different Canadian mines (Mohanty,
1987) and granites and tuffs (Cho et al., 2003) to study the strain rate dependency of the dynamic
tensile strength. Conventional SHPB tests were conducted using Brazilian disc method on
marbles (Wang et al., 2006; Wang et al., 2009) and argillites (Cai et al., 2007). In these dynamic
Brazilian tests on SHPB, the dynamic loads to the sample are taken as the average of the two
interfacial loads on both ends of the sample; and a standard quasi-static equation for determining
the tensile strength are utilized. For quasi-static and low speed Brazilian tests, it is reasonable to
use the standard static equation to calculate the tensile strength. However, for dynamic Brazilian
test conducted with SHPB featuring stress wave loading, the application of the quasi-static
equation to the data reduction has not yet been rigorously checked. The pulse-shaper technique
(Frew et al., 2002; Frew et al., 2005; Song and Chen, 2004) can facilitate dynamic force balance
and thus reduce the inertial effect, but the extent of such reduction is not adequately examined.
Recently, two types of dynamic indirect tension tests were proposed and examined, i.e. Brazilian
tests and semi-circular bend flexural tests performed on SHPB to measure the tensile strength
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 23
(Dai et al., 2010c) and flexural strength (Dai et al., 2008) of Laurentian granite. The differences
between the two strength values measured from two methods are discussed (Dai et al., 2010d).
The methods are then employed to research on the anisotropic Barre granite (Dai and Xia, 2010).
The details are presented in later chapters.
2.3 Fracture Tests
2.3.1 Static Fracture Tests
2.3.1.1 Fracture toughness
In recent years, rock fracture mechanics has been applied as a possible tool for solving a variety
of rock engineering problems, including rock cutting, hydro-fracturing, explosive fracturing,
underground excavation, and rock mass stability (Chen et al., 2008). Rock fracture mechanics is
established within the framework of linear elastic fracture mechanics, which assumes the
material of interest is linear elastic. Rock fracture mechanics is essentially extended from the
Griffith theory (1920) and Irwin’s modification (1957) which recognizes the importance of stress
intensity near a crack tip (Chen et al., 2008).
Irwin introduced the concept of stress intensity factor (SIF) to describe the stress and
displacement field near a crack tip. Depending on the applied stress experienced by the crack, a
crack propagates with the superposition of three basic failure modes, as shown in 4Figure 2.6:
Mode I is the tension/opening mode, where the principal load is applied in a direction normal to
the crack plane, tending to open the cracks (4Figure 2.6a); Mode II is the in-plane shear mode, in
which the load tend to slide one crack face with respect to the other (4Figure 2.6b); Mode III is the
tearing mode or out of plane mode, in which the crack faces are sheared parallel to the crack
front (4Figure 2.6c) (Anderson, 2005). Thus, corresponding to the three fracture modes, there are
three types of SIFs: Mode I (KI), Mode II (KII) and Mode III (KIII).
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 24
Figure 2.6 The three basic modes of crack propagation: (a) Mode I, opening mode; (b) Mode II, in-plane shearing; (c) Mode III, tearing mode.
Mode-I fracture is the most encountered fracture mode in nature as well as engineering practice.
Take Mode-I fracture as an example, to express the stress field and displacement field ahead of
the crack tip. 4Figure 2.7 illustrates an element near the tip of a crack in an elastic material; the
stress components of the element are also denoted. The stress fields ahead of the Mode-I crack
tip in an isotropic linear elastic material can be written as the following:
⎥⎦⎤
⎢⎣⎡ −= )
2sin()
2sin(1)
2cos(
2θθθ
πσ
rK I
xx (2.1a)
⎥⎦⎤
⎢⎣⎡ += )
23sin()
2sin(1)
2cos(
2θθθ
πσ
rK I
yy (2.1b)
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 25
)2
3cos()2
sin()2
cos(2
θθθπ
σr
K Ixy = (2.1c)
StrainPlaneStressPlane
v yyxxzz
⎩⎨⎧
+=
)(0σσ
σ (2.1d)
0== yzxz ττ (2.1e)
Figure 2.7 Definition of the local coordinate axis ahead of a crack tip. Z direction is normal to the plane.
The displacement relationship for Mode-I are:
⎥⎦⎤
⎢⎣⎡ +−= )
2(sin21)
2cos(
222 θκθ
πr
GK
u Ix (2.2a)
⎥⎦⎤
⎢⎣⎡ −+= )
2(cos21)
2sin(
222 θκθ
πr
GK
u Iy (2.2a)
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 26
where G is the shear Modulus. v43−=κ for plane strain and )1/()3( vv +−=κ for plane stress.
The critical value of the SIFs when crack propagation initiates is defined as the fracture
toughness (i.e. for Mode-I, KIC; Mode-II, KIIC; and Mode-III, KIIIC). Fracture toughness thus
serves as a measure of the ability of a material to resist the growth of a preexisting crack under
loading. Fracture toughness of rocks is the most important material property in rock fracture
mechanics. For quasi-brittle geological materials, crack propagation is the major cause of
material failure in many cases. Thus, assessment of fracture toughness is important to the
understanding of failure behavior of structures involving geological materials (Chang et al.,
2002). As stressed by Sun and Ouchterlony (1986), some applications of the fracture toughness
of rocks are listed as below:
(i) A parameter for classifying rock materials;
(ii) An index for fragmentation processes such as tunnel boring and rock blasting;
(iii) A material property in the modeling of rock fragmentation like hydraulic fracturing,
explosive simulation of gas wells, radial explosive fracturing, and crater blasting as well as in
stability analysis.
4Figure 2.8 contrasts the fracture mechanics approach with the traditional tensile strength
approach for structural design and material selection. In the traditional strength approach, the
material is believed to be adequate or the structure is believed to be safe if the induced tensile
stress by the applied stress is lower than the tensile strength. In the fracture mechanics approach,
the fracture toughness is an analogy of the tensile strength; but instead of only one variable, i.e.
applied stress, additional variable is the flaw size, and both the flaw size and the applied stress
contribute to the stress intensity factor (SIF).
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 27
Figure 2.8 Comparison of the fracture mechanics approach to design with the traditional strength of material approach: (a) strength approach (b) fracture toughness approach.
2.3.1.2 Rock fracture tests
As a material parameter of rocks, the fracture toughness of rocks can be obtained by designed
experiments. Thus, laboratory testing of fracture toughness of rocks aim at developing
convenient rock samples to determine the critical SIFs using analytical or numerical methods
with experimental recorded loadings as input. In this thesis, the Mode-I fracture will be dealt
with because the opening mode is the most often encountered failure mode; and even for
macroscopic shear or mixed mode failure, opening mode fracture has been observed
microscopically (Ashby and Sammis, 1990; Horii and Nematnasser, 1986; Rawling et al., 2002).
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 28
While in earlier attempts of measuring fracture toughness of rocks, ASTM-E399 standard
(ASTM Standard E399-09, 2009) has been followed, which is developed for measuring plane
strain fracture toughness of metallic materials. For brittle geo-materials like rocks, the nature of
fracture process in rocks (brittle) is different from that in most metals (plastic yielding); the
fracture specimens are generally sampled directly from rock cores to avoid the pre-damage
during sample fabrication. Thus, direct application of such standards to rocks remains
inconvenient. Special sample geometries should be developed for fracture toughness
measurements of rocks. Various methods have been proposed in the literature to measure
fracture toughness of rocks, including radial cracked ring (Chen et al., 2008; Shiryaev and Kotkis,
1982), semi-circular bend (SCB) (Chong and Kuruppu, 1984; Lim et al., 1994a; Lim et al.,
1994b; Lim et al., 1994c), chevron-notched SCB (Kuruppu, 1997), Brazilian disc (Guo et al.,
1993), and cracked straight through Brazilian disk (CSTBD) (Atkinson et al., 1982; Chen et al.,
1998b; Fowell and Xu, 1994).
The International Society of Rock Mechanics (ISRM) also proposed short rod (SR) and chevron
bending (CB) tests in 1988 (Ouchterlony, 1988) and cracked chevron notched Brazilian disc
(CCNBD) in 1995 (Fowell et al., 1995). Three types of specimens have been widely used for
determining the pure Mode I fracture toughness of rocks by Ingraffea et al. (1984) on limestone
and granite, Swan and Alm (1982) and Sun and Ouchterlony (1986) on Stripa granite, Gunsallus
and Kulhawy (1984) on sandstone, Ouchterlony (1987) on granite and marble, Shetty et al. (1985)
and Fowell and Xu (1994) on ceramics and rocks, and Backers et al. (2003) on sandstone. All of
those specimens are core-based, which facilitate sample preparation from cores obtained from
natural rock masses.
To calculate the pure Mode I SIF, myriads of analytical and numerical methods have been used
in the literature. Some examples summarized by Ke et al. (2008) are as follows: an approximate
integral solution (Libatskii and Kovchik, 1967); the Fredholm equation (Rooke and Tweed,
1973); boundary collocation method (Isida, 1975); the modified mapping-collocation method for
orthotropic rectangular plates (Gandhi, 1972); an analytical expression to solve an infinite
cracked plate; the dislocation and boundary collocation methods with the superposition
procedure for a Brazilian disc with a central crack (Guo et al., 1993), the dislocation and
boundary collocation methods with the superposition procedure for a Brazilian disc with a
central crack (Awaji and Sato, 1978), a distributed dislocation method for cracked Brazilian disc
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 29
(Atkinson et al., 1982); the dislocation method combined with the superposition technique for
cracked straight through Brazilian disc (CSTBD) (Fowell and Xu, 1994); the weight function
method for Brazilian disc with a central crack (Dong et al., 2004). Finite element method has
also been widely used to calculate the Mode I SIF. For example, Murakami (1976) proposed a
simple procedure for the accurate determination of stress intensity factors by the conventional
finite element method; Fischer et al. (1996) used the finite element method combined with the
modified ring test; Lim et al. (1993) used the finite element method to calibrate the SIF for
semicircular specimen under three-point bending loading; Wang et al. (2003) used the ANSYS
sub-model technique in finite element analysis for cracked chevron notched Brazilian disc
(CCNBD).
2.3.2 Dynamic Fracture Tests
2.3.2.1 Early fracture tests
Dynamic fracture plays a vital role in geophysical processes and engineering applications (e.g.,
earthquakes, airplane crashes, projectile penetrations, rock bursts and blasts). Dynamic fracture
problems are branched into two categories: one is the fracture initiation of a static crack under
dynamic loading; the other is a dynamic fracture propagation or arrest of a propagating crack
(Freund, 1990). The dynamic fracture toughness is the key parameter determining the dynamic
fracture initiation of a static crack; and the dynamic fracture energy is associated with the
process of a propagating crack. Accurate measurements of these dynamic fracture parameters
involving fracture toughness and fracture energy are prerequisites for understanding mechanisms
of dynamic fracture and also useful for engineering applications.
Dynamic fracture tests under higher loading rates are more complicated than static ones. This is
due to the inertia effects associated with stress wave propagation in the samples. In early
dynamic fracture experiments, Charpy pendulum impact was widely used to investigate dynamic
fracture behavior of materials. There is a recommended ASTM standard (i.e. ASTM E24.03.03,
1980, proposed standard method for instrumented impact testing of pre-cracked Charpy
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 30
specimens of metallic materials) for dynamic fracture toughness tests using Charpy impact
testing with loading rate less than 105 MPa.m1/2s-1. As pointed out by Jiang and Vecchio, many
studies have shown that the conventional Charpy impact test has significant drawbacks as
follows (Jiang and Vecchio, 2009):
1) The dynamic load is realized by physic motion of the hammer. Lack of understanding of the
inertial forces associated with stress wave propagation in the Charpy specimen, the experimental
results are hard to interpret. The stress intensity factor is greatly influenced by the complex
waves (Böhme, 1988).
2) The load obtained from strain gauges mounted on the hammer is different from that applied on
the specimen due to the strong inertial effect. The load may be underestimated due to inertial
effects. In addition, the significant frequency oscillations in the recorded loading evolution make
it difficult to accurately determine the critical load for a fracture (Lorriot et al., 1998).
3) The conventional quasi-static data analysis is no longer applicable for dynamic fracture
toughness reduction since the bending sample is in a non-equilibrium stress condition, due to the
huge inertial effects through the course of the impacting (Böhme and Kalthoff, 1982).
4) The rampant impacting of the pendulum on the sample can cause an unexpected “lost-of-
contact” between the sample and the supporting bases. In that case, the so-called three point
impacting test is actually degenerated into one point impacting (Böhme and Kalthoff, 1982;
Kalthoff, 1985; Marur, 2000).
2.3.2.2 Fracture tests with Hopkinson bar
Hopkinson pressure bar testing, originally developed for dynamic compression tests of
engineering materials, has been modified for conducting dynamic fracture tests of materials
based on one dimensional stress-wave propagation theory.
The loading stress pulse includes both compressive and tensile pulses, and the loading methods
adopted for Hopkinson bar experimental technique include one-bar, two-bar, and three-bar
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 31
setups (Jiang and Vecchio, 2009). For example, compressive stress pulse loaded bending fracture
tests may involve one-bar/one-point bend (1PB) impact (unsupported) (Homma et al., 1991;
Rizal and Homma, 2000; Wada, 1992; Weisbrod and Rittel, 2000), one-bar/three-point bend
(3PB) impact (Bacon, 1993; Bacon et al., 1994; Irfan and Prakash, 2000; Mines and Ruiz, 1985),
two-bar (incident and transmitted bars)/3PB (Jiang et al., 2004b; Tanaka and Kagatsume, 1980),
two bar/4PB (Weerasooriya et al., 2006), and three bar (one incident bar and two transmitted
bars, either of transmitted bars as a support)/3PB impact (Yokoyama and Kishida, 1989). Several
specimen geometry configurations corresponding to different Hopkinson bar testing systems
have been proposed. Under tensile stress pulse loading, configurations include edge notched
tensile samples (Owen et al., 1998), double-edge notched tensile sheet samples (Xia et al., 1994),
and center notched tensile samples (Lambert and Ross, 2000). Under compressive stress pulse,
configurations include notched bending samples (Jiang et al., 2004b; Tanaka and Kagatsume,
1980; Weerasooriya et al., 2006), wedge-loaded compact tension (WLCT) specimens loaded by
a compressive pulse (Klepaczko, 1979), compact compressive specimens (CCSs) (Rittel et al.,
1992), and Brazilian disk specimens (Dai et al., 2010a; Lambert and Ross, 2000; Zhou et al.,
2006).
For determining dynamic fracture parameters such as load, displacement, and fracture time,
strain gauge techniques and optical techniques have been used. It can be concluded from the
literature that: 1) Hopkinson pressure bar compressive stress pulse is more popular than the
tensile stress pulse loading technique; 2) that the strain gauge method is widely utilized for
measuring crack initiation time; 3) that quasi-static fracture mechanics theory is applicable for
dynamic fracture toughness measurement under the condition of stress-equilibrium, and 4) that
finite element analysis (FEA) is a fundamental and frequently used method for computing the
dynamic stress-intensity factor. Major developments of the Hopkinson bar based fracture tests in
the literature are highlighted here below 2chronologically according to a recent critical review
(Jiang and Vecchio, 2009).
1977 Hopkinson tensile pulse is employed by Costin et al. (1976) for loading a pre-fatigued
cylinder sample (long bar sample) for fracture toughness measurement, initiating the application
of Hopkinson bar technique in material fracture toughness testing.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 32
1978 Reflected tensile pulse is introduced for loading single-edge cracked samples in a
pressure bar setup by Stroppe et al. (1978).
1979 WLCT sample experimental method is presented by Klepaczko (1979) for determining
dynamic fracture toughness, KId, using Hopkinson pressure bar.
1980 Two-bar (transmitted tube)/3PB loading testing system is proposed for measuring
dynamic load and deflection responses by Tanaka and Kagatsume (1980).
1983 Stress-state equilibrium issue is first considered in Hopkinson compressive bar loaded
CT sample fracture tests by Corran et al. (1983).
1985 One-bar (incident bar)/3PB fracture test method is established by Mines and Ruiz (1985)
as an improvement to classical Charpy impact testing.
1989 Three-bar/3PB fracture test is proposed for dynamic fracture toughness measurement,
and loss-of-contact under stress-wave loading is identified by a simple transverse wave
propagation analysis by Yokoyama and Kishida (1989).
1990 Pulse shaping is employed for reducing the dynamic effect in two-bar/3PB fracture
testing by Ogawa and Higashida (1990).
1991 One-bar bending fracture test is proposed by Homma et al. (1991) for measuring fracture
toughness of polymethyl mechacrylate.
1992 Two-bar/CCS fracture test is presented by Rittel et al. (1992) for determining fracture
toughness of steel.
1992 Brazilian disk samples are used by Nakano et al. (1992) in measuring Mode I and Mixed
Mode I/II fracture toughnesses for brittle materials.
1993 Two-point strain gauge measurement is employed for determining load and load-point
displacement in one-bar/3PB testing by Bacon (1993).
2003 Two-bar/3PB fracture toughness test is proposed by Nwosu et al. (2003) for measuring
Mode II delamination fracture toughness of composite material.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 33
2004 Momentum-tripping technique is adopted in an improved Hopkinson pressure bar loaded
fracture test by Jiang et al. (2004b).
2006 Two-bar/four-point bend (4PB) is proposed by Weerasooriya et al. (2006) for
determining dynamic fracture toughness of ceramic materials.
2007 “Loss-of-contact” is investigated experimentally in a two-bar/3PB testing system by
Jiang and Vecchio (2007a; 2007b) using a novel contact voltage measurement method, and
pulse-shaping effect is reexamined in a two-bar/4PB setup.
2.3.2.3 Dynamic rock fracture tests
Limited attempts have been made to measure the dynamic initiation fracture toughness of rocks.
Using specially designed fast loading material testing machines, Costin (1981), Wu (1986) and
Bazant et al. (1993) measured the fracture toughness of oil-shale, marble, granite and limestone
using three-point bending specimens.
Tang and Xu (1990) tried to measure dynamic fracture toughness of rocks by three point impact
using a single Hopkinson bar. The dynamic load was measured by a load sensor attached to the
impacting bar, and the groove-opening displacement of the sample was also measured optically.
To do this, a synchronous light-chink device was mounted on the sample. By recording the
luminous flux passing through the narrow chink during the test, the groove-opening
displacement was simultaneously monitored. The load is found to increase linearly until a point
Cp, after which the displacement rate D(t) increases sharply. This turning point Cp, in their view,
is the critical point of cracking. The dynamic fracture toughness KIc is then determined from the
stress intensity factor at the critical point using a standard quasi-static equation.
Zhang et al. (1999, 2000) conducted first SHPB measurements on dynamic fracture toughness of
rocks using short-rod specimens through wedge loading. The time-resolved dynamic loadings on
both ends of the specimen were deduced using the standard SHPB data process with waves
recorded by pairs of strain gauges mounted on the incident bar and transmitted bar respectively.
CHAPTER 2: LITERATURE REVIEW 34
A dynamic Moiré method was used to determine the fracture initiation time. Two optical
gratings were glued to each side of the specimen separated by the main crack plane. The centers
of both gratings are placed on the same section of the tip of the pre-machined crack. During
dynamic fracture, the crack-open-displacement (COD) increases with time. As soon as the crack
approaches the critical state, the rate of the COD reaches an extreme value. This moment was
considered as the critical time tc. The critical compressive force acting on the wedge was thus
determined, and so did the critical stress intensity factor (i.e. fracture toughness) through a quasi-
static equation.
Wang et al. (2010) used two types of holed cracked flattened Brazilian disc samples
diametrically impacted by SHPB to measure the dynamic fracture toughness of marbles. In their
methods, the dynamic loading P(t) on the sample was taken as the average of loads on both
loading interfaces of the sample and the bar; and this loading P(t) was used as input in the
dynamic finite element analysis to deduce the dynamic stress intensity factor KI(t). The fracture
initiation time tf of the disc specimen was resolved from the signal of the strain gauge cemented
on the sample surface near the crack tip. The dynamic fracture initiation toughness was then
taken as the stress intensity factor at the fracture time tf from the evolution curve of dynamic
stress intensity factor.
Compared to the dynamic fracture toughness tests of rocks, even fewer researches have been
tried to measure dynamic fracture energy of rocks directly. There is only one report on the direct
measurement of the energy consumption during the dynamic fracture of rocks. This work done in
2000 by Zhang et al. (2000) was a continuing research of their previous paper published in 1999
(Zhang et al., 1999) to further investigate the energy dissipation during the dynamic rock fracture.
In their work, a high-speed camera was used to estimate the fragment velocities, from which, the
residual fragment kinetic energy was calculated. The total energy consumption can be deduced
from the strain gauge signals considering both the kinetic energy of bar material particles and the
elastic strain energy. The fracture energy and the damage energy thus can be obtained based on
the first law of thermodynamics.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 35
CHAPTER 3
EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES
The experimental setup and the working principles are presented, along with procedures of
sample preparations for tension, flexural and fracture tests. Novel techniques in SHPB,
including pulse shaping technique, momentum trap technique and laser gap gauge system are
discussed.
3.1 Samples Preparations
3.1.1 Laurentian Granite
An isotropic fine-grained granitic rock, Laurentian granite is one of the two rocks used in this
research. The mineralogical and mechanical characteristics of Laurentian granite are well
documented (Nasseri et al., 2005). This granite is used to demonstrate and validate the proposed
methods for dynamic tensile, flexural and fracture tests conducted in SHPB. Laurentian granite is
taken from the Laurentian region of Grenville province of the Precambrian Canadian Shield,
north of St. Lawrence and north-west of Quebec City, Canada. The mineral grain size of
Laurentian granite varies from 0.2 to 2 mm with the average quartz grain size of 0.5 mm and the
average feldspar grain size of 0.4 mm, with feldspar being the dominant mineral (60%) followed
by quartz (33%). Biotite grain size is of the order of 0.3mm and constitutes 3–5% of this rock
(Nasseri et al., 2005).
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 36
4Figure 3.1 illustrates the procedures for preparing testing samples of Brazilian disc (BD) samples
for tension tests, semi-circular bend (SCB) samples for flexural tests and notched semi-circular
bend (NSCB) samples for fracture tests. Rock cores with a nominal diameter of 40 mm are first
drilled from a rock block and then sliced to obtain discs with an average thickness of 16 mm. All
the disc samples are polished afterwards resulting in a surface roughness variation of less than
0.5% of the sample thickness. These discs are the samples for Brazilian disc (BD) tests. The
semi-circular bend (SCB) samples are subsequently made from the discs by diametrical cutting.
These SCB samples are prepared for flexural tests. A notch with approximately 1 mm thickness
is then machined using a rotary diamond-impregnated saw from the center of the disc
perpendicular to the diametrical cut. These are the notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) samples
for fracture tests.
Figure 3.1 Procedures for preparing three types of samples: Brazilian disc (BD), semi-circular bend (SCB) and notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) samples.
It is noted that sufficient crack tip sharpness is necessary for accurately measuring fracture
initiation toughness (Bergmann and Vehoff, 1994; Suresh et al., 1987). For an ideal crystal, the
naturally formed crack has a finite thickness of the order of atomic spacing; for a polycrystalline
solid, the thickness is comparable to its grain size. The thickness of an intergranular crack is on
the order of the characteristic material length (e.g., the average grain size in a polycrystalline
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 37
solid). In the experiments, a 1 mm wide notch was first made in the semi-circular rock disc and
then sharpen the tip with a diamond wire saw to achieve a tip diameter of 0.5 mm. The average
grain size of Laurentian granite is about 0.59 mm (Iqbal and Mohanty, 2007; Nasseri and
Mohanty, 2008), so the diameter of the crack tip is similar to the thickness of naturally formed
cracks. This will ensure accurate measurements of fracture toughness. Indeed, as discussed by
Lim et al. (1994b) and references therein, if the notch radius is smaller than 0.8 mm, there is no
change of measured fracture toughness for rocks they used.
3.1.2 Barre Granite
Barre granite is the anisotropic rock chosen for this study because it exhibits a high degree of
anisotropy (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008). In addition, it was designated as part of a standard rock
suite by the U.S. Bureau of Mines (Goldsmith et al., 1976). It is aimed to investigating the rate
dependency of anisotropy of mechanical properties tested from three tests, as well as their
relationship with pre-existing microcracks aligned in preferred directions. Barre granite is
obtained from the southwest region of Burlington in Vermont, USA. It is an intrusive deposit of
Devonian age, concordant on a regional scale but discordant at local contacts. It is a fine to
medium grained rock with mineral grain sizes ranging from 0.25 to 3 mm. Quartz makes up 25%
(by volume) of this rock and has an average grain size of 0.9 mm. Feldspar is the dominant
mineral (65%) and has an average grain size of 0.83 mm. The average grain size for biotite (6%)
is 0.43 mm. The microcracks are of either the intragranular or intergranular type and are found in
quartz and feldspar grains, and along cleavage planes of biotite grains (Xia et al., 2008).
Microcracks orientation in Barre granite has been investigated and it has been reported that there
is a strong concentration of microcracks within the rift plane (plane of easiest splitting) and the
hard way (plane of hardest splitting) (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008; Nasseri et al., 2005). The
Barre granite block used in this research is directly taken from quarried stones with clear
identification of three principal planes. P-wave velocities are then measured along three
orthogonal axes of the block, which is labeled as X, Y and Z axes with respect to slow (3.57
km/s), intermediate (4.00 km/s) and high P-wave velocity (4.75 km/s) respectively (4Figure 3.2).
Sano et al. (1992) determined the principal axes of Barre granite by measuring the P-wave and S-
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 38
wave velocities in various directions of propagation and polarization. In their paper, the P-wave
velocities along three principal axes are 3.540 km/s, 3.985 km/s and 4.655 km/s respectively,
very similar to current measurements. Micro-structural examination of thin sections is then
conducted to further confirm the three orthogonal principal directions of the chosen block. 4Figure
3.2 illustrates the 3D relationships between the three sets of microcracks inferred from the
petrographical studies along the three orthogonal axes marked with P-wave velocities. The first
microcrack set runs parallel with the YZ plane (rift plane), the second microcrack set is found to
be parallel to the XZ plane (grain plane), and the third set runs parallel with the XY plane (hard
way or most resistive plane) in Barre granite using the convention of directions in the paper.
When preparing the three types of samples, a similar procedure of fabrication is followed as that
for Laurentian granite. The samples of Barre granite are cored and labeled using the three
principal anisotropic directions shown in 4Figure 3.2. Rock cores with a nominal diameter of 40
mm are first drilled along X- Y- and Z- directions from the same rock block. For each core, the
other two principal directions are also marked. The rock cores are then sliced to obtain disc
samples with an average thickness of 16 mm. All the disc samples are polished afterwards; and
two in-plane principal directions are labeled accordingly. The BD samples were prepared in this
way. The diametrical loading directions are chosen along the two in-plane principal directions.
The rule of nomenclature for the Brazilian disc groups is also shown schematically in 4Figure 3.2
(e.g. 4Figure 3.2a for sample YX), with the first index representing the normal of the disc fracture
plane and the second index indicating the loading direction. Therefore six groups
(directions/configurations), namely XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX, and ZY are prepared in this research.
When preparing SCB samples and NSCB samples, the BD samples are first cut diametrically
along the other two in-plane principal material axes to obtain SCB samples. The NSCB samples
are fabricated from SCB samples following the sample fabrication procedures as that for
Laurentian granite samples. The rule of nomenclature is the same as that for the BD samples of
Barre granite, with the first index representing the normal of the potential fracture plane and the
second index indicating the loading direction or the splitting direction. An example of the YX
sample of SCB and NSCB are schematically shown in 4Figure 3.2b and c. In this way, six sample
groups, namely XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX, and ZY are prepared for all three types of samples (i.e.
BD, SCB, NSCB) in this research.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 39
Figure 3.2 3D block diagram showing longitudinal wave velocities and the sampling location of Brazilian discs prepared along each plane with respect to microcrack orientations in Barre granite; the first index for sample numbering represents the direction normal to the splitting plane, and the second index indicates the propagation direction of the crack, e.g. Sample YX of (a) BD sample; (b) SCB sample; (c) NSCB sample; the dashed lines depict the failure plane.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 40
3.2 MTS Hydraulic Servo-control System
The static tests are conducted on an MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system (4Figure 3.3).
Testing Star-II (digital controller) is used to control the testing process and MTS Testing Ware-
SX software is used to set the testing parameters. The loading rate applied is based on the
standard testing of rocks in tension (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978) and in fracture (Fowell et al.,
1995). For example, for Brazilian tests, a constant loading rate of 200 N/s is applied on all the
tests. The entire load and displacement histories are measured with linear variable displacement
transducers (LVDT) and a 50 kN load cell respectively.
Figure 3.3 Photoes of (a) semi-circular bend and (b) Brazilian test of rock samples in the MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 41
3.3 Split Hopkinson Pressure Bar
The Hopkinson bar experimental technique rooted in the stress wave experiments of iron wires
performed by John Hopkinson (Hopkinson, 1872; Hopkinson, 1901), and later by his son
Bertram Hopkinson (Hopkinson, 1905). A decade later, B. Hopkinson (Hopkinson, 1914)
developed the pressure bar technique to experimentally determine the pressure produced by an
explosive. In 1948, Davies used electrical condenser units in conjunction with oscilloscopes to
record the wave propagation in the pressure bar for the first time (Davies, 1948). The following
year, H. Kolsky proposed and used the split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) to determine the
dynamic compression stress-strain behavior of different materials (Kolsky, 1949). In this
modification, he divided the pressure bar into two parts, which are later called incident/input bar
and transmitted/output bar respectively. These classic studies have established the foundation for
the experimental methods and data analysis strategy of the state-of-the-art SHPB.
The SHPB technique is increasingly becoming the standard method of measuring material
dynamic mechanical properties in the strain rate range 102~104 s-1 for a variety of engineering
materials, such as metals (Gray, 2000), composites (Ninan et al., 2001), concrete (Ross et al.,
1996; Ross et al., 1995), ceramics (Chen and Ravichandran, 2000; Chen and Ravichandran, 1996;
Chen and Ravichandran, 1997), and rocks (Dai et al., 2010c; Xia et al., 2008; Zhang et al., 2000;
Zhang et al., 1999).
3.3.1 Working Principle
A 25 mm in diameter SHPB system is used in the study. 4Figure 3.4 shows the photo of the SHPB
setup at the department of Civil Engineering and Lassonde Institute of the University of Toronto.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 42
Figure 3.4 Photo of a split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system in the Department of Civil Engineering, University of Toronto.
SHPB is composed of three bars: striker bar, incident bar, and transmitted bar (Gray, 2000). The
specimen is sandwiched between the incident bar and the transmitted bar. For the system used in
this research, the length of the striker bar is 200 mm. The incident bar is 1500 mm long and the
strain gauge location is 733 mm from the impact end of the bar. The transmission bar is 1200
mm long and the stain gauge station is 655 mm away from the sample. An infrared detector
system is used together with a two-channel TDS1021 digital oscilloscope to measure the velocity
of the striker bar. An eight-channel Sigma digital oscilloscope by Nicolet is used to record and
store the strain signals collected from the Wheatstone bridge circuits after amplification.
As shown in 4Figure 3.5, during the test, a striker bar is launched by the gas gun; and the impact
of the striker bar on the free end of the incident bar induces a longitudinal compressive wave
propagating in both directions. The left-propagating wave is fully released at the free end of the
striker bar and forms the trailing end of the incident compressive pulse (4Figure 3.5). Upon
reaching the bar-specimen interface, part of the incident wave is reflected (reflected wave) and
the remainder passes through the specimen to the transmitted bar (transmitted wave). The time of
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 43
passage and magnitude of these three elastic pulses through the incident and transmitted bars are
recorded by strain gauges.
Figure 3.5 Schematics of a split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system and the x-t diagram of stress waves propagation in SHPB.
4Figure 3.6 shows the strain gauge data measured as a function of time for the three wave signals
during the dynamic compression testing of a Barre granite sample. The incident and transmitted
wave signals represent compressive loading pulses, while the reflected wave is a tensile wave.
Using the wave signals from the strain gauges on the incident and transmitted bars as a function
of time, the forces and velocities at the two interfaces between the pressure bars and the
specimen can be determined. The input strain pulse, reflected strain pulse and transmitted strain
pulse are denoted as εi(t), εr(t) and εt(t), respectively (4Figure 3.5).
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 44
0 200 400 600 800-0.12
-0.09
-0.06
-0.03
0.00
0.03
0.06Reflected wave
Transimitted wave
Out
put (
V)
Time (μs)
Incident wave
Figure 3.6 Strain-gauge data, after signal conditioning and amplification, from a SHPB compression test of a Barre granite sample showing the three stress waves measured as a function of time.
Based on the one dimensional stress wave theory, the dynamic forces on the incident end (P1)
and the transmitted end (P2) of the specimen are (Kolsky, 1949; Kolsky, 1953):
)(1 riAEP εε += , tAEP ε=2 (3.1)
The displacement of the incident bar end (u1) and the transmitted bar end (u2) integrated from the
respective velocities (v1 and v2):
dtCut
ri∫ −=01 )( εε , dtCu
t
t∫=02 ε (3.2)
In the above equations, E is the Young’s Modulus of the bar material, A is the cross-sectional
area of the bar, and C is the one dimensional longitudinal stress wave velocity of the bar.
The histories of strain rate )(tε& , strain )(tε and stress )(tσ within the sample in the dynamic
compression tests (4Figure 3.5) can be calculated as:
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 45
⎪⎩
⎪⎨
⎧
++=−−=
−−=
∫)()(
)()()()(
02
0
triAA
t
triLC
triLC
Etdtt
t
εεεσεεεε
εεεε&
(3.3)
where L is the length of the sample and A0 is the initial area of the sample. Assuming the stress
equilibrium prevails during dynamic loading (i.e., tri εεε =+ ), the commonly used formulas are
obtained:
⎪⎩
⎪⎨
⎧
=−=
−=
∫tA
A
t
rLC
rLC
Etdtt
t
εσεε
εε
0)()()(
02
2&
(3.4)
When the specimen deforms uniformly, the strain rate within the specimen is directly
proportional to the amplitude of the reflected wave. Similarly, the stress within the sample is
directly proportional to the amplitude of the transmitted wave. The reflected wave is also
integrated to obtain strain and is plotted against stress to give the dynamic stress-strain curve for
the specimen.
3.3.2 Pulse Shaping
The loading pulse of the conventional SHPB system for materials testing at high strain rates have
an approximately trapezoidal shape acompanied with high level of oscillations. The oscillations
induced by the sharp rising portion of the incident wave causes difficulty in achieving dynamic
stress equilibrium state in the sample. However as discussed before, all the calculation equations
deduced in the SHPB tests requires stress equilibrium in the sample. The results determined from
these calculation equations will induce sizeable errors if a stress non-equilibrium dominates the
sample.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 46
In a review paper by Franz et al. discussing the incident pulse shaping for SHPB experiments
with metal samples (Frantz et al., 1984), the authors emphasized that a slowly rising incident
pulse is a preferred loading pulse in order to minimize the effects of dispersion and inertia; and
thus facilitate dynamic stress equilibrium of the sample. Franz presented experimental results to
show that a properly chosen tip material or pulse shaper can not only provide stress equilibrium
in the sample but also generate a nearly constant strain rate in the sample (Frantz et al., 1984).
Gray and Blumenthal also discussed these issues in their recent review paper (Gray, 2000). To
shape the incident pulse, one way is to modify the shape of the striker. For example, Christensen
et al. used striker bars with a truncated-cone on the impact end in an attempt to produce ramp
pulses (Christensen et al., 1972); Franz used a machined striker bar with a large radius on the
impact face to generate a slowly rising incident pulse for the tests (Frantz et al., 1984); Li et al.
used tapered striker to generate an approximate half-sine loading waveform (Li et al., 2000).
Another way, and a more convenient way is to place a small, thin disc made of soft materials
between the striker and the incident bar. The disc is called the pulse shaper and can be made of
paper, aluminum, copper or stainless steel, with 0.1–2.0 mm in thickness. For examples, Wu and
Gorham used paper shapers on the impact surface of the incident bar to eliminate high frequency
oscillations in the incident pulse for SHPB tests (Wu and Gorham, 1997). Togami et al. used a
thin plexiglass disk to produce non-dispersive compression pulses in an incident bar (Togami et
al., 1996). Chen used a polymer disk to spread the incident compressive pulses for experiments
on silicone rubber (Chen et al., 1999). Song and Chen employed a C11000 half-hardened copper
disk as the front pulse-shaper, and two C11000 annealed copper disks as the rear pulse shapers to
control the profiles of the loading and unloading portions of the incident pulse so that dynamic
stress–strain loops of the subject material can be accurately determined (Song and Chen, 2004).
Given the wide application of the pulse shaper techniques in the SHPB tests, models have been
developed by researchers to guide the design parameters of the shaper. Nemat-Nasser et al.
modeled the plastic deformation of an OFHC copper pulse shaper, predicted the incident strain
pulse, and showed good agreement with some measured incident strain pulses (Nemat-Nasser et
al., 1991). Ravichandran and Subhash presented a method of characteristics analysis for wave
motions in a ceramic sample and provided a criterion for dynamic stress equilibrium
(Ravichandran and Subhash, 1994). Frew et al. extended the work by Ravichandran and Subhash
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 47
(1994) to obtain high rate stress–strain data for limestone samples (Frew et al., 2001). They also
presented data showing that the ramp pulse durations could be controlled such that samples could
be unloaded just prior to failure (Frew et al., 2001).
The pulse shaping technique virtually eliminates high frequency oscillations in stress waves,
resulting in a smooth loading pulse and a significant improvement in the interpretation of the
dynamic response. It is especially useful for investigating dynamic response of brittle materials
such as rocks (Frew et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002). Without proper pulse shaping, it is difficult
to achieve dynamic stress equilibrium in such materials because the sample may fail immediately
from its end in contact with the incident bar when it is impacted by the incident wave. In
hlaboratory, the pulse shaper technique has been used to achieve the dynamic force equilibrium,
during dynamic rock tension and fracture testing. To transform the incident wave from a
rectangular shape to a ramped shape, the main pulse shaper is made up of a thin C11000 copper
disc (with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.7 mm in thickness). In addition, a small rubber disc (0.64
mm in diameter and 0.3 mm in thickness) is placed in front of the copper shaper to further reduce
the slope of the pulse to a desired value, as schematically shown in 4Figure 3.7a.
During tests, the striker impacts the pulse shapers before the incident bar, thus generating a non-
dispersive ramp pulse propagating into the incident bar and thus facilitating the dynamic force
balance in the specimen (Frew et al., 2001; Frew et al., 2002). The function of the pulse shaper is
to 1) fill out the high frequence noice generated during the impacting and 2) maintain force
equilibrium across the sample. A wide variety of incident pulses can be produced by varying the
geometry of the copper disks as shown in 4Figure 3.7b. Curve A is obtained using a C11000
copper disc as a pulse shaper with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.2 mm in thickness; Curve B, a
C11000 copper disc shaper with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.35 mm in thickness; Curve C, a
C11000 copper disc shaper with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.7 mm in thickness and a small
rubber disc with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.3 mm in thickness; Curve D, a C11000 copper disc
shaper with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.8 mm in thickness and a small rubber disc with 0.64 mm
in diameter and 0.3 mm in thickness. Depending on the materials of testing as well as the loading
rate of interest, different loading pulse is needed and can be achieved with proper shaper design.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 48
Striker Bar Incident Bar
CopperRubber
0 50 100 150 200 2500.00
0.02
0.04
0.06
0.08
0.10
0.12
0.14
0.16
D
CB
Vol
tage
(v)
Time (μs)
without shaper
A
(a) (b)
Figure 3.7 Pulse shapers in SHPB (a) schematic of the assembly (b) unshaped and shaped incident stress pulses.
3.3.3 Momentum Trap
In the traditional SHPB system, the stress pulse travels along the incident bar and load the
sample at its ends; part of the wave is transmitted to the transmitted bar through the specimen
between the incident bar and the transmitted bar. The remaining part of the stress pulse is
reflected back, propagating along the incident bar as tension wave, termed as reflection wave. At
the free end of the incident bar, this tension wave is reflected one more time as compression
wave and reloads the sample. By the same token, the sample may be subjected to multiple
loading due to the stress waves traveling back and forth along the bars. This will make it
impossible to correlate the loading history to the deformation or fracture profiles from the
recovered samples.
To ensure a single loading to be applied on the sample, many applications have been attempted
to prohibit additional loadings on the sample. For example, in compression tests, special fixtures,
such as “stopper rings,” can be used to limit the total axial strain of the sample; as long as the
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 49
sample length equals that of the ring, the stopper ring “stops” the loading on the sample by
sustaining the remaining compression pulse. However, for hard and brittle materials with very
small failure strain, such as ceramics and rocks, the “stopper-ring approach” is difficult to
implement. This is because for this class of materials, once microcracks have been generated in
these brittle solids by the initial pulses, the subsequent reflected compression pulses will
inevitably shatter the specimen, making recovery of the sample essentially impossible (Nemat-
Nasser et al., 1991).
To remedy this problem, a momentum trap system similar to that proposed by Song and Chen
(2004) has been developed in this research. A photo of the momentum trap system of SHPB
setup is shown in 4Figure 3.8a, which is composed of a momentum transfer flange that is attached
to the impact end of the input bar and a rigid mass that is attached to the supporting I beam for
the whole bar system.
Figure 3.8 The momentum-trap system: (a) the actual image and (b) the x–t diagram showing its working principle.
As showed in 4Figure 3.8b inset, there is a gap between the flange and the rigid mass. The
distance of the gap d is determined by the velocity of the striker 0v , the length of the input bar l
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 50
and the shape of the input pulse. It takes Clt /20 = for the reflected wave to arrive at the impact
end of the incident bar. The reflection wave is then reflected and changed from the tensile wave
to compression wave at the input end. As a result, it will exert dynamic compression on the
sample for a second time. In a similar manner, the sample in a conventional SHPB set up
experiences multiple compressive loading. The main idea of the momentum-trap method is to
absorb the first reflection by a big mass that can be considered as rigid because of its large
impedance (which is equal to CAρ , where ρ is density) compared to the bar. It is required that
when the reflection wave arrives at the front end of the input bar, the flange is in contact with the
big mass. As a result, the reflection wave is stopped by the big mass. This requirement is
expressed as:
∫= 0
0)(
t
i dttCd ε (3.5)
If there is no pulse-shaper between the striker and the input bar, the particle velocity of the input
bar after impact is 1/2 0V , for the case where the striker and input bar are made of the same
material. Denote the length of the striker by sl , the total duration of the loading pulse is Cls /2 ,
which is usually smaller than Clt /20 = . The total displacement of the end of the incident bar
(flange), which is equal to the gap between the flange and the rigid mass that need to be set in
advance is then ∫= 0
0)(
t
i dttCd ε = ∫1
0 02/1t
dtV = ClV s /0 . If there is a pulse-shaper between the
striker and the incident bar, the measured incidence pulse should be used to determine the size of
the gap using Equation (3.5).
As an example shown in 4Figure 3.9, the second compression is indeed reduced a lot so that the
sample will experience essentially single pulse loading (positive: compression; negative: tension).
It is noted that after the 1st incident and reflection, the 2nd incident wave is tensile, which will
separate the incident bar from the sample. The single loading pulse is thus ensured in the
dynamic SHPB tests with momentum-trap. The 2nd reflected wave in 4Figure 3.9 is compressive,
induced by the total reflection of the 2nd incident wave from the free surface of the incident bar
end that is separated from the specimen.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 51
Figure 3.9 Comparison of stress waves from the incident bar, with and without momentum trap; the legends refer to the stress wave with trap.
3.4 Laser Gap Gauge System
The application of the photoelectronic method on the SHPB testing was first suggested by
Wright and Lyon (1959) and was later utilized by Griffith and Martin (1974) to monitor the
displacements of the end faces of cylindrical carbon-fibre composite specimen in the dynamic
SHPB tests. By recording the luminous flux of light passing through the fabricated notch of the
sample, Tang and Xu (1990) measured the groove-opening displacement of the three point
bending fracture sample during dynamic one bar impact tests. The source light used in their tests
was regular white light. With the development of modern photoelectronic techniques, white light
was replaced by a better and stable source of light, the laser. Using self-developed laser line
velocity sensor system, Ramesh and Kelkar (1995) invented a technique for continuously
measuring the projectile velocities in the plate impact experiments. A similar laser system, Laser
Occlusive Radius Detector (LORD), was applied on the Kolsky bar (split Hopkinson pressure
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 52
bar) tests by Ramesh and Narasimhan (1996) to measure the radial strain of the deformed
samples of plastic materials. Li and Ramesh (2007) extended the optical technique, LORD, to the
tension Kolsky bar testing for measuring dynamic tension properties of four viscoplastic
materials.
3.4.1 Principles and Setup
In the dynamic fracture tests reported in Chapter 6, a laser gap gauge (LGG) system was
developed by Chen et al., (2009) to monitor the opening of the notch of the NSCB sample and
thus reduce the opening velocity of the cracked fragments. As shown in 4Figure 3.10, the system
consists of two major components: the collimated line laser source and the sensing system.
The laser operates at 670 nm with a 5 mW output power. It has a large field depth and minimal
variations in thickness across the line length. The line is 30 μm thick at 185 mm away, and the
divergence angle is 5°. A cylindrical lens is used to achieve a parallel laser sheet. The plano-
convex cylindrical lens is made from coated BK7 glass. The high performance multilayer anti-
reflection coatings have an average reflectance of less than 0.5 % (per surface) in the wavelength
range of 650-1050 nm. The light detection part consists of a collecting lens and a photodiode
light detector. The collecting lens focuses the incoming laser light into the photodiode detector,
which is placed near its focal point. A narrow-band-pass filter centered at 670 nm is placed in
front of the detector window. The photodiode detector output is pre-amplified, and the
optoelectronics and the preamplifier together have a bandwidth of 1.5 MHz. The output voltage
of the detector is proportional to the total amount of laser light collected. The whole system has a
noise level less than 0.4 mV.
The LGG is mounted perpendicular to the bar axis and the laser passes through the notch in the
center of the specimen. During the test, as the notch opens up, the amount of light passing
through increases, leading to higher voltage output from the detector. The voltage is linearly
proportional to the gap width and thus the crack surface displacement distance can be reduced.
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 53
Figure 3.10 Photo and schematics of the laser gap gauge (LGG) system set up perpendicular to the bar axis of SHPB.
3.4.2 Calibration of the System
3.4.2.1 Static calibration
Calibration of LGG is conducted under both static and dynamic conditions. For static calibration,
a set of high precision gauges is used to partly block the probe laser (4Figure 3.11). The blocking
width ranges from 0 to 10 mm at a step of 0.1 mm. A specific blocking width (d) corresponds to
a light-passing width Δd and a certain amount of voltage reading (ΔU) in the detector output
( 4Figure 3.11).
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 54
0.0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 .00
1
2
3
4
Δd (m
m)
ΔU (V)1
X
d
Collimated beam Gap gauge
Measurement Linear fitting
Figure 3.11 Static calibration of the LGG system using a gap gauge blocking the collimated beam: schematic setup and the calibration result.
The Δd -ΔU curve exhibits a good linearity, indicating the high uniformity of the laser sheet:
Ukd Δ=Δ (3.6)
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 55
where k=4.08 mm/V is the calibration parameter of the LGG system. Denote the standard
deviation as σ, and the error propagation follows from Equation (3.6) as:
22 )/()/(/ Ukd Ukd Δ+≈Δ ΔΔ σσσ (3.7)
Here σk=0.03 mm/V, and σΔU=0.4 mV. As an example, for ΔU = 0.25 V, Δd = 1.02 mm and the
relative error of the displacement measurement is around 0.8 %.
3.4.2.2 Dynamic calibration
The dynamic calibration is carried out with a single Hopkinson bar. In order to get higher cutoff
frequency, a miniaturized 6.35 mm diameter Hopkinson bar is utilized to calibrate the LGG
system. The cutoff frequency fc of a long bar is (Graff, 1975):
vRC
fc02
23.0
π= (3.8)
where R0 is the bar radius, ν and C are Poisson’s Ratio and elastic wave velocity, respectively. fc
is 400 kHz for the 6.35 mm diameter bar, much higher than 100 kHz for the 25 mm diameter bar.
One end of the incident bar is impacted with the striker bar and the LGG is used to monitor the
motion of the other end. When the compressive wave arrives at the free end of the incident bar, it
is reflected as a tensile wave. The incident and reflected waves measured from the strain gauge
glued on the incident bar. The strain signals are corrected for the travel time from the gauge to
the free end of bar. Then the displacement of the free end follows as (Kolsky, 1953):
∫ +=Δt
ri Cdd0
)( τεε (3.9)
where t denotes time. With the LGG output, the displacement of the free end of the incident bar
can be calculated using Equation (3.6) for comparing the values obtained with Equation (3.9).
CHAPTER 3: EXPERIMENTAL SETUP AND TECHNIQUES 56
The comparison shows excellent agreement (4Figure 3.12), demonstrating that the LGG system
has a wide bandwidth sufficient for valid measurements in SHPB.
0 100 200 300 4000.0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
D
ispl
acem
ent (
mm
)
Laser Gap Gauge Strain Gauge
t (μs)
Laser beamX
Incident bar
Figure 3.12 Dynamic calibration of the LGG system: schematic setup and a typical dynamic testing result compared to the predictions by Equation (3.6).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 57
CHAPTER 4
DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS
In this chapter, a dynamic Brazilian disc testing method is proposed to measure the dynamic
tensile strength of rocks using split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB). Both traditional and pulse
shaped SHPB tests are conducted to validate the dynamic Brazilian tests method on SHPB with
isotropic Laurentian granite for demonstration. This method is then applied to investigate
tensile strength of anisotropic Barre granite along six directions. The rate dependence of the
tensile strength anisotropy has been observed and the correlation to the microstructure of Barre
granite has been stated.
4.1 Background Studies
Granites may naturally exhibit anisotropy due to pre-existing microcracks that are preferentially
oriented (Sano et al., 1992; Takemura et al., 2003). The granite chosen in this research is Barre
granite, a widely investigated anisotropic granite. It has been confirmed that the splitting planes
and anisotropy of Barre granite are mainly caused by microcracks with scanning electron
microscope (SEM) and transmission electron microscope (TEM) techniques (Schedl et al., 1986).
Tension-type failure is encountered in a wide range of rock engineering applications. It is thus
important to characterize the tensile strength of anisotropic rocks (i.e. Barre granite) in general
and to understand the correlation between strength and the microcracks in specific. In many
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 58
mining and civil engineering applications, such as quarrying, rock cutting, drilling, tunnelling,
rock blasts, and rock bursts, rocks are stressed dynamically. Accurate characterizations of rock
tensile strength over a wide range of loading rates are thus crucial.
For static tension tests, there are various methods that have been proposed for measuring the
tensile strength of rocks. Due to the difficulties associated with experimentation in direct tensile
tests, indirect methods were proposed to serve as convenient alternatives to measure the tensile
strength of rocks; some examples are the Brazilian disc test (Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978;
Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), the ring test (Coviello et
al., 2005; Hudson, 1969; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), and the bending test
(Coviello et al., 2005). The sample preparation and experimental instrumentation for these
indirect tests are much easier than the direct pull test. Among these indirect methods, the
diametrical compression of thin disc specimen, generally referred to as the Brazilian test, is
probably the most popular one. It has been suggested by the International Society for Rock
Mechanics (ISRM) as a recommended method for tensile strength measurement of rocks
(Bieniawski and Hawkes, 1978). The disc sample used is thus termed Brazilian disc (BD).
Brazilian tests have also been chosen by many researchers to measure the indirect tensile
strength of anisotropic rocks and investigate the effect of anisotropy on the tensile strength.
Examples are Berenbaum and Brodie on coals (Berenbaum and Brodie, 1959), Evans on coals
(Evans, 1961), Hobbs on siltstones, sandstones and mudstones (Hobbs, 1964), Mclamore and
Gray on shales (Mclamore and Gray, 1967), Barla on gneisses and schists (Barla, 1974), and
Chen et al. on four types of bedded sandstones (Chen et al., 1998a).
Brazilian test has also been extended to the dynamic tests for measuring the dynamic tensile
strength of brittle solids like rocks. Using Brazilian test, Zhao and Li (2000) measured the
dynamic tensile properties of granite with a fast hydraulic loading system. For achieving even
higher loading rates, researchers resort to the split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB), which is
widely considered as a standard dynamic testing machine. For examples, dynamic Brazilian tests
were conducted in conventional SHPB system on marbles (Wang et al., 2006; Wang et al., 2009)
and argillites (Cai et al., 2007). These attempts followed the pioneer work on dynamic Brazilian
tests of concretes using SHPB (Ross et al., 1995; Ross et al., 1989). For quasi-static and low
speed Brazilian tests, it is reasonable to use the standard static equation to calculate the tensile
strength. However, for dynamic Brazilian tests conducted with SHPB featuring stress wave
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 59
loading, the application of the quasi-static equation to the data reduction has not been rigorously
checked yet.
In this chapter, both static and dynamic Brazilian tests are conducted to investigate the
anisotropic Barre granite. For dynamic Brazilian test conducted with SHPB, a rigorous
assessment will be carried out on the validation of the tests using both traditional and pulse
shaped tests with the aid of high speed photograph. This chapter is arranged as follows. Section
4.2 will present the schematics of the dynamic Brazilian test in SHPB. Section 4.3 validates the
proposed dynamic Brazilian test. In section 4.4, the tensile strength anisotropy of Barre granite is
characterized under a wide range of loading rates with evaluated methods. The result is
interpreted in terms of the microstructure of Barre granite. Section 4.4 summarizes the chapter.
4.2 Dynamic Brazilian Test
A close-view of the dynamic Brazilian test in the SHPB system is schematically shown in 4Figure
4.1, where the disc sample is sandwiched between the incident bar and the transmitted bar. The
principle of Brazilian test comes from the fact that rocks are much weaker in tension than in
compression. The diametrically loaded rock disc sample fails first due to the tension along the
loading diameter near the centre. The calculation equation of tensile strength is based on the 2D
elastic analysis as (Michell, 1900):
DBPf
t πσ
2= (4.1)
where Pf is the load when the failure occurs, σt is the tensile strength, D and B are the diameter
and the thickness of the disc, respectively.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 60
B
D
Incident Bar Transmitted Bar
strain gauge
P1 P2
Figure 4.1 Schematic of the Brazilian test in a SHPB system. The Brazilian disc, with a thickness B = 16 mm and diameter D= 40 mm, is sandwiched between the incident and transmitted bars. A strain gauge is mounted on the specimen near the disc centre.
A strain gauge is glued on the disc surface with 5 mm away from the centre of the disc (4Figure
4.1) to detect the rupture onset. This is only for evaluation purpose in Section 4.3. The center
point of the disc emits elastic release waves upon cracking, and this wave causes sudden strain
drop in the recorded strain gauge signal (Jiang et al., 2004a). The peak point of the strain gauge
signal right before the sudden drop corresponds to the arrival of the release wave due to fracture
initiation. It is noted that the original strain gauge signal should be shifted considering the time
the elastic wave propagates from disc centre to the strain gauge.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 61
4.3 Validation of Dynamic Brazilian Test
4.3.1 Dynamic Brazilian Test without Pulse Shaping
4.3.2.1 Dynamic forces and failure sequences with high speed camera
Traditionally, by the direct impact of the striker on the free end of the incident bar in a SHPB test,
the generated incident wave is a square compressive stress wave with a very sharp arising
portion, which is accompanied by high frequency oscillations. As a result, the dynamic forces on
both ends of the sample vary significantly. 4Figure 4.2 depicts a large oscillation of dynamic force
occurring on the incident side and a sizeable distinction between P1 and P2.
0 30 60 90 120
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
Forc
e (k
N)
Time (μs)
In. Tr.(P2) Re. In.+Re.(P1)
Figure 4.2 Dynamic forces on both ends of the Laurentian granite disc specimen tested using a traditional SHPB without pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
For a valid Brazilian test, the disc sample should break first along the loading direction
somewhere near the centre of the disc. To verify this, a Photron Fastcam SA1 high speed camera
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 62
is used to monitor the fracture processes of the Brazilian disc (BD) without pulse shaping. The
high speed camera is placed perpendicular to the sample surface with images taken at an inter
frame interval of 3.8 μs. The failure process of this test without shaping the loading incident
wave is shown as 4Figure 4.3.
Figure 4.3 High-speed video images of a typical dynamic Brazilian test on Laurentian granite without pulse shaping.
The time zero corresponds to the moment when the incident pulse arrives at incident bar-sample
interface. It can be observed that the first breakage emanates from the incident side of the sample
at around 36 μs after the incident wave arrives at the bar/ sample interface. Soon after that,
damages also appear from the transmitted side of the sample (see the image at 55 μs). Thus, the
splitting of the disc (see, the image at 93 μs) is triggered by the damages at the loading points
through a “wedging” process to the centre of the disc. It thus can be concluded that in this case,
the working principle of a Brazilian test is violated. The rectangular incident loading wave with a
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 63
sharp rising edge (4Figure 4.2) seems to affect the failure mode of the testing sample significantly.
Since the cracking of the BD initiates from the loading ends, not from somewhere near the centre
of the disc, the standard equation [i.e. Equation (4.1)] is invalid for reducing the tensile strength
from the tensile stress history at the disc centre.
4.3.2.2 Evaluation of the quasi-static BD equation
The dynamic finite element analysis represents the accurate stress history at any point inside the
disc. A commercial finite element software ANSYS is employed in the calculation. The finite
element model is meshed with quadrilateral eight-node element PLANE82, with a total of 4,800
elements and 14,561 nodes (4Figure 4.4).
Assuming linear elasticity, this analysis solves the following equation of motion with the
Newmark time integration technique:
u&&ρ=⋅∇ σ (4.2)
where σ is the stress tensor, ρ denotes density, and u&& is the second time derivative of the
displacement vector u. The input loads in the finite element model are taken as the dynamic
loading forces exerted on the incident and transmitted side of the specimen, which are calculated
using Equation (4.1) with measured waves.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 64
P1 P2
Figure 4.4 Mesh of the Brazilian disc for the finite element analysis with ANSYS; P1 and P2 are the diametrical forces on both loading ends.
4Figure 4.5 shows the evolutions of tensile stress and compressive stress at the disc centre
calculated from both static analysis (i.e. standard Brazilian equation) and dynamic finite element
analysis. The static analysis is carried out with Equation (4.1) using the transmitted force on the
sample ( 4Figure 4.1). The overall trends of the two curves match with each other but the dynamic
ones feature fluctuations. Furthermore, the dynamic tensile stress is far from linear and therefore
it is difficult to achieve a constant tensile loading rate. Consequently, the tensile stress from the
quasi-static data reduction with the far-field load recorded from the transmitted bar cannot reflect
the transient tensile stress history in the Brazilian disc. The usage of the far-field loads such as
the transmitted force to obtain the tensile stress with standard Brazilian test will lead to very
large errors in the result.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 65
0 30 60 90 120-100
-80
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
Com
pres
sive
Stre
ss (M
Pa)
Time (μs)
Quasi-static Dynamic
0 30 60 90 120
-10
0
10
20
30
40
Tens
ile S
tress
(MP
a)
Time (μs)
Quasi-static Dynamic
(b)
(a)
Figure 4.5 (a) Tensile stress σx (b) compressive stress σy histories at the center of a Brazilian disc from dynamic finite element analysis and quasi-static equation in a typical SHPB Brazilian test on Laurentian granite without pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 66
The peak value of the transmitted force P2(t) is normally taken as Pf for standard Brazilian
equation [Equation (4.1)] to calculate the material tensile strength (Cai et al., 2007). Therefore,
the onset instant of fracture as identified from the strain gauge history recorded on the specimen
should coincide (approximately) with the peak instant of P2(t) after appropriate time corrections.
4Figure 4.6 compares the strain gage signal with the dynamic forces P1(t) and P2(t). The strain
gage signal features significant fluctuation with three peaks. This scenario cannot be traced from
the transmitted wave which shows only signal peak. In contract, the strain gauge signal is
markedly affected by the force on the incident side of the sample [P1(t)], which also exhibits
large fluctuation. The inertial effect dominates in the dynamic test. The transmitted force in this
case cannot be regarded as the bearing load to the sample, and its peak does not coincide with the
rupture time. Therefore, the tensile strength in the sample cannot be deduced from far-field
measurement via quasi-static analysis.
0 30 60 90 120-2.0
-1.5
-1.0
-0.5
0.0
0.5
1.0
Strain gauge Tr. In.+Re.
Time (μs)
Vol
tage
(V)
-10
0
10
20
30
40
50
Force (kN)
Figure 4.6 Comparison of strain gage signal with the dynamic forces on both loading ends of the disc in a dynamic Brazilian test on Laurentian granite using a traditional SHPB without pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 67
4.3.2 Dynamic Brazilian Test with Careful Pulse Shaping
4.3.2.1 Dynamic forces and failure sequences with high speed camera
4Figure 4.7 illustrates the time-varying forces in a typical test with careful pulse shaping. The
incident wave is shaped to a ramp pulse with a rising time of 180 µs, and a total pulse width of
300 µs. It is evident that the time-varying forces on both sides of the samples are almost identical
before the peak point is reached during the dynamic loading. The resulting forces on both side of
the sample also feature a linear portion before the peak, thus facilitating a constant loading rate
via σ& =2k2/(πDB), where the parameter k2 is illustrated in 4Figure 4.7.
0 50 100 150 200 250 300-30
-20
-10
0
10
20
30
40
Forc
e (k
N)
Time (μs)
In. Tr.(P2) Re. In.+Re.(P1)k2
Figure 4.7 Dynamic forces on both ends of a Laurentian granite disc specimen tested using a modified SHPB with careful pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
High speed camera is also used to capture the failure sequences of the BD sample with force
balance achieved in the test. 4Figure 4.8 presents the key frames with representative features. In
sharp contrast to the images from the non-pulse-shaped Brazilian tests, this disc cracks near the
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 68
centre and the primary crack occurs at around 160 μs. The crack then propagates bilaterally to
the loading ends. The next two frames illustrate the splitting trajectory of the sample before it is
completely split into two fragments approximately along the centre line of the sample in the last
frame (4Figure 4.8). It is also noted that after the initiation of the primary crack, one secondary
crack is visible near the loading ends at time instant 236 μs. Since the splitting of the disc
initiates near the centre, the tensile strength can be determined as long as the tensile stress of the
disc at failure can be accurately determined. Next, we need to evaluate whether the standard BD
equation [i.e. Equation (4.1)] can be used to deduce the tensile strength.
Figure 4.8 High-speed video images of two typical dynamic Brazilian tests on Laurentian granite with careful pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 69
4.3.2.2 Validation of quasi-static BD equation
For a conventional dynamic compression test with SHPB or direct tension test with split
Hopkinson tension bar (SHTB), the sample is cylindrical and thus the force balance on the ends
ensures the stress equilibrium throughout the sample. However, the disc is two dimensional (2D);
force balance on the boundaries (4Figure 4.7) does not necessarily ensure dynamic equilibrium
within the entire sample. A further comparison of the stress history at a point of interest from full
dynamic analysis with that from quasi-static analysis is necessary.
The transient dynamic stress history at the disc centre (potential failure spot) is calculated and
compared with that from a quasi-static analysis using Equation (4.1). The histories of the stress
components σx (in tension) and σy (in compression) for dynamic and quasi-static finite element
analyses are compared in 4Figure 4.9(a) and (b) respectively. The stress states at the disc centre
from both quasi-static and dynamic data reductions match with each other. Thus, provided force
balance on the sample ends, the quasi-static analysis with the far-field loading measured as input
can accurately represent the stress history in the sample.
4Figure 4.10 shows the signal of the strain gauge mounted on the sample, compared with the
transmitted force. Only one peak (A) of the signal is registered by the stain gauge, occurring at
time 149 µs. Thus, the breakage initiation time is designated by the peak A at the time of 149 µs.
Because the peak transmitted force occurs at time 152.5 µs, it is thus delayed only by 3.5 µs after
the measured onset of breakage. It is concluded that in this case, the peak far-field load matches
with the breakage onset with negligibly small time difference. The small time difference of 3.5
µs can be interpreted as follows. The release waves travel at the sound speed of the rock material
(around 5 km/s) and the distance between the fracture location and the supporting pin is 20 mm.
It thus takes around 4 µs for the first release wave to reach the supporting pins, where the
transmitted wave is recorded and also illustrated in 4Figure 4.10. Due to the interaction between
the release wave and the pins, the load on the transmitted side decreases (4Figure 4.10). Thus, the
peak of the transmitted force can be regarded as synchronous with the single peak of the strain
gauge signal (the rupture onset).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 70
0 50 100 150 200 250 300
-60
-45
-30
-15
0
15
Com
pres
sive
Stre
ss (M
Pa)
Time (μs)
Quasi-static Dynamic
0 50 100 150 200 250 300-5
0
5
10
15
20
Tens
ile S
tress
(MP
a)
Time (μs)
Quasi-static Dynamic
(b)
(a)
Figure 4.9 (a) Tensile stress σx (b) compressive stress σy histories at the center of a Brazilian disc on Laurentian granite from both dynamic and quasi-static finite element analyses in a typical SHPB Brazilian test with pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 71
0 50 100 150 200 250 300
-0.4
-0.3
-0.2
-0.1
0.0
0.1
0.2
0.3
3.5 μs
Strain gauge Tr.
Time (μs)
Vol
tage
(V)
0
5
10
15
20
Force (kN)
A
B
Figure 4.10 Comparison of the strain gage signal with the transmitted force for a dynamic Brazilian test on Laurentian granite using a modified SHPB with careful pulse shaping.
From 4Figure 4.9 and 4Figure 4.10, it thus can be concluded that, provided force balance has been
achieved on both ends of the Brazilian disc, the dynamic tensile strength can be calculated from
the quasi-static equation. For the particular test shown above, the measured tensile strength in the
SHPB Brazilian test with proper pulse shaping is calculated to be 18.9 MPa at a loading rate of
233 GPa/s.
The above validation demonstrates that in a modified SHPB test with proper pulse shaping, the
dynamic force balance within the Brazilian disc can be achieved. Thus, the tensile stress state at
the disc centre can be calculated with simple quasi-static analysis. Moreover, high-speed
photography visualizes that the disc sample failures near the center of the disc rather than the
loading ends. The rupture time synchronizes with the peak of the transmitted pulse recorded in
the SHPB system after corrections for travel time. Therefore, the dynamic tensile strength can be
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 72
calculated from the peak of the transmitted wave measured in the SHPB system with quasi-static
analysis.
Thus, despite the 2D configuration of the Brazilian disc in the SHPB testing, as long as the force
balance on both ends of the sample can be guaranteed, it is highly feasible to achieve stress
equilibrium in the sample and also the synchronization of the rupture onset with the peak of the
transmitted pulse in brittle rocks as shown above, and the simple quasi-static analysis is valid for
data reduction. This method thus provides an efficient way of determining the dynamic tensile
strength of rocks.
4.3.2.3 Necessity of using the loading jaws in dynamic BD tests
It is noted that in the ISRM suggested Brazilian test method, two steel loading jaws are used to
transfer the load to the disc shaped rock samples diametrically over an arc angle of
approximately 10° at failure (Bieniawski and Bernede, 1979). The jaws are designed to reduce
the localized stress concentration at the loading ends and thus to prevent the failure at the loading
ends. This technique works well for static loading while for SHPB tests, the extra interfaces
between the bar and the jaw will complicate the wave stress propagation and increase the
difficulties of experimentation. Furthermore, in the foregoing high speed camera snapshots of the
dynamic Brazilian test without jaws, no obvious pre-mature breakages are observed. It is thus
concluded that for SHPB tests, the loading jaws might not be necessary. To further assess this
postulation, two sets of dynamic BD tests, one with jaws and one without jaws, were conducted.
These tests were conducted with careful pulse shaping and thus the dynamic force balance was
achieved in all tests.
The radius of the jaws is chosen as 30 mm, 1.5 times of the radius of the disc sample as
suggested by the ISRM standard (Bieniawski and Bernede, 1979). 4Figure 4.11 illustrates the
measured tensile strength of Laurentian granite from dynamic Brazilian tests with and without
employing curved jaws at the loading ends; the insert in 4Figure 4.11 shows the sample assembly
with the loading jaws. The consistency of the strength values from two sets of tests clearly
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 73
confirmed previous assumption. The simplicity of the experimentation will facilitate the
standardization of the dynamic BD method using SHPB.
0 1000 2000 3000
20
30
40
50
Tens
ile S
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading Rate (GPa/s)
With jaws Without jaws
Front jaw Rear jaw
Figure 4.11 The measured tensile strength of Laurentian granite from dynamic Brazilian tests with and without employing jaws.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 74
4.4 Tensile Strength of Barre Granite
4.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Tensile Strength
4.4.1.1 Stress distribution in the disc sample
For the static test, the disc samples are compressed diametrically with loading platens in the
MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system. 4Figure 4.12(a) schematically shows the loading
scheme of a Brazilian disc, where D and B are the diameter and the thickness of the disc,
respectively and P is the diametrical load. For the dynamic test, the disc specimen in the SHPB
system is shown schematically in 4Figure 4.12(b), where the sample disc is sandwiched between
the incident bar and the transmitted bar.
P1
B
D
P2
(a)
B
D
P
P
(b)
Incident Bar Transmitted Bar
x
y
x
y
y
z
z
y
Figure 4.12 Schematics of a Brazilian test in (a) the material testing machine and (b) the SHPB system.
Let x, y, z be a global Cartesian coordinate system shown in 4Figure 4.12, the y-axis defines the
loading direction and the z-axis denotes the axial direction of the disc. In the quasi-static elastic
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 75
equilibrium, the components of the stress tensor for any point (x, y) in the disc can be expressed
as follows:
xxx fDBP
⋅=π
σ 2, yyy f
DBP
⋅=π
σ 2, xyxy f
DBP
⋅=π
τ 2 (4.3)
where σx, σy and τxy are three components of the stress tensor and fxx, fyy and fxy are the
corresponding components of the dimensionless stress tensor and can be calculated using
numerical tools according to Equation (4.4). Compression is positive in the following
calculations.
DBP
f xxx
π
σ2
= ,
DBP
f yyy
π
σ2
= ,
DBP
f xyxy
π
τ2
= (4.4)
To measure the indirect tensile strength of anisotropic rocks by Brazilian test, a thorough
analysis of the stress state in the anisotropic disc is required. In this work, finite element analysis
using ANSYS is conducted to analyze the stress state in the anisotropic rock disc for all the six
sample configurations. Quadrilateral eight-node element PLANE82 is used in the analysis, and
the finite element model consists of 4,800 elements and 14,561 nodes in total. Barre granite is
considered orthotropic and the nine stiffness constants Cijkl has also been documented (Sano et al.,
1992) as C1111= 32.70 GPa, C2222= 41.69 GPa, C3333= 56.17 GPa, C2323= 20.59 GPa, C3131= 17.67
GPa, C1212= 15.78 GPa, C2233= 6.43 GPa, C3311= 3.93 GPa, C1122= 3.45 GPa. For comparison
purpose, the stress state of the Brazilian disc is also analyzed assuming that the rock is isotropic.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 76
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
-0.8
-0.6
-0.4
-0.2
0.0
0.8
0.2
0.4
0.20.
4
0.8
-0.8
-0.6
-0.4
-0.2
0.2
0.4
0.8 0.8
0.20.4
0.00.0
0.0
5.0
5.0
3.3
4.2
3.3
4.2
2.5
1.7
0.8 2.5
1.7
0.8
-1.0
-0.75
-0.25
-0.5
-1.0
-0.75
-0.5
-0.25
1.0
0.75
0.250.5
0.750.50.25
1.0
0.0 0.0
0.0
0.0
0.20.
4
0.80.8
0.2
0.4
-0.8
-0.6
-0.4
-0.2
-0.8
-0.6
-0.4
-0.2
0.0
0.00.0
0.0
0.2
0.4
0.8 0.8
0.20.4
2.5
1.7
0.8 2.5
1.7
0.8
5.0
5.0
3.3
4.2
3.3
4.2
-1.0
-0.75
-0.5
-0.25
0.0
0.750.50.25
1.0
0.0
0.0
0.0
1.0
0.75
0.250.5
-1.0
-0.75
-0.25
-0.5
Figure 4.13 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy with isotropic model, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample YX using anisotropic model (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 77
For the isotropic case, 4Figure 4.13a, b and c show the distribution of the dimensionless stress
components fxx, fyy and fxy respectively. The calculated values of fxx, fyy and fxy at the centre of the
disc (potential failure spot) are fxx ~ -1, fyy ~ 3 and fxy = 0, respectively. For anisotropic case, eight
sample configurations XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX, and ZY are analyzed; and similar symmetrical
stress contours as the isotropic case are observed (see 4Figure 4.15, 4Figure 4.16 and 4Figure 4.17).
The stress trajectories of the fxx, fyy and fxy for sample YX are illustrated and compared with that
for isotropic case in the 4Figure 4.13d to f. The tensile stress distribution near the centre of the
disc is quite uniform for the anisotropic YX sample (4Figure 4.13d and e), very similar to the
isotropic case ( 5Figure 4.13a and b). The shear stress components (5Figure 4.13f) along the loading
diameter and the horizontal diameter are zero due to the intentional coring and loading along
three predetermined material symmetrical plane X, Y and Z. Therefore, the fxx and fyy along the
loading direction in the 5Figure 4.13d and 5Figure 4.13e accurately represent the dimensionless in-
plane principal stress σ1 and σ2.
A complete suite of stress trajectories of the fxx, fyy and fxy for Brazilian disc under quasi-static
deformation for the isotropic case and six anisotropic sample configurations are illustrated in
5Figure 4.14, 5Figure 4.15, 5Figure 4.16 and 5Figure 4.17.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 78
(a)
(b)
(c)
Figure 4.14 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy with isotropic model.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 79
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 4.15 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample XY, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample XZ (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 80
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 4.16 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample YX, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample YZ (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 81
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 4.17 Stress trajectories of a Brazilian disc of Barre granite under quasi-static deformation. (a) fxx, (b) fyy and (c) fxy for sample ZX, and (d) fxx (e) fyy and (f) fxy for sample ZY (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 82
4.4.1.2 Tensile strength
Using Equation (4.3), the stress state at any point within the disc can be fully determined by the
three dimensionless stress components fxx, fyy and fxy. 5Figure 4.13 shows that for points along the
loading diameter of the anisotropic Brazilian disc, the shear stress is zero and the tensile stress is
almost constant near the centre of the disc. In addition, the corresponding compressive stress is
very similar to the isotropic case with a value around three times of the tensile stress. The
vanishing of the shear stress components along the loading diameter implies the coincidence of
the in-plane principal stress σ1 and σ2 with σx and σy. For the tensile strength determination for
anisotropic Barre granite in this study, we use the same assumption as Chen et al. (1998a) that
the indirect tensile strength is given by the maximum absolute value of the tensile stress σx
perpendicular to the loading diameter at the disc centre:
FDBPf
t ⋅=π
σ2
(4.5)
where σt is the tensile strength and Pf is the load when the failure occurs. F is fxx at the centre of
the disc with coordinates (0, 0). The calculated dimensionless factors F for all sample
configurations as well as the material properties used in the finite element analysis are tabulated
in 5Table 4.1.
Table 4.1 The material properties used in the finite element model of BD samples of Barre
granite along six directions.
Sample Suites
F
xE (GPa)
yE (GPa)
xyG (GPa)
xyv
XY 0.9215 40.7 32.2 15.8 0.093 XZ 0.8334 54.8 32.2 17.7 0.105 YX 1.0452 32.2 40.7 15.8 0.073 YZ 0.9112 54.8 40.7 20.6 0.146 ZX 1.1058 32.2 54.8 17.7 0.062 ZY 1.0769 40.7 54.8 20.6 0.108
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 83
For Brazilian tests conducted in the MTS system, the quasi-static equation, Equation (4.4) is
accurate while for dynamic Brazilian tests in the SHPB system, a quasi-static stress state in the
sample disc during the test has to be checked before Equation (4.4) is used. This is because in
dynamic tests, there exists the so-called inertial effect associated with stress wave loading as
shown by Böhme and Kalthoff (1982). This inertial effect will lead to errors in data reduction if a
quasi-static analysis is used. Using the pulse-shaper technique in SHPB tests (Frew et al., 2002),
it has been demonstrated in the previous section that the dynamic forces on both ends of the
specimen can effectively minimize the inertial effect even for complicated sample geometry as
Brazilian disc specimen (Dai et al., 2010c).
4.4.2 Tensile Strength Anisotropy
4.4.2.1 Dynamic equilibrium
In order to guarantee a quasi-static state in the dynamic Brazilian test, pulse shaping technique is
deployed for all the dynamic tests. The dynamic force balance on the two loading ends of the
sample is critically assessed. To compare the force histories of these two, the time zeros of the
incident and reflection stress waves are shifted to the sample-incident bar interface and the time
zero of the transmitted stress wave is shifted to the sample-transmitted bar interface invoking 1D
stress wave theory. 5Figure 4.18 compares the time-varying forces on both ends of the sample in
the typical test with pulse shaping. It is evident from 5Figure 4.18 that with pulse shaping, the
dynamic forces on both sides of the samples are almost identical before the critical failure point
is reached during the dynamic loading.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 84
0 40 80 120 160-40
-20
0
20
40
In. Re. In.+Re. (P1) Tr. (P2)
Forc
e (k
N)
Time (μs)
Figure 4.18 Dynamic force balance check for a typical dynamic Brazilian test of Barre granite with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
5Figure 4.19 and 5Figure 4.20 shows the exemplars of the virgin Brazilian discs and recovered disc
samples after the tests. It is noted that for all the dynamic Brazilian disc tests, the momentum
trap technique in the SHPB system is also used. Thus, all BD samples are subjected to single-
pulse loading with the momentum trap technique, which prevents further damage to the sample
due to the multiple loading pulses. The disc samples are split diametrically along the loading
directions, as shown in 5Figure 4.20. Several secondary cracks can be seen in some recovered
samples. As proven previously by high-speed camera images, this scenario will not affect the
tensile strength determination with dynamic Brazilian tests via SHPB.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 85
Figure 4.19 Virgin Brazilian discs of Barre granite prepared for the test; each division in the scale denotes 1 mm.
Figure 4.20 Recovered Brazilian discs of Barre granite after tests; each division in the scale denotes 1 mm.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 86
4.4.2.2 Static tensile strength anisotropy
The static tensile strength values are taken as the average of three individual tests for each
sample group. 5Figure 4.21a depicts the variation of static tensile strength measured along six
different directions of Barre granite. The measured static tensile strength exhibits very strong
anisotropy. The average tensile strength for the two sample configurations with the same
splitting plane X (i.e. XY, XZ) yields the lowest tensile strength of 9.5±0.14 MPa and 8.8±0.11
MPa respectively; configurations with the splitting plane Y (i.e. YX, YZ) owns intermediate
tensile strength of 13.0±0.17 MPa and 11.8±0.10 MPa; whereas the configurations with the
splitting plane Z (i.e. ZX, ZY) exhibit the highest strength values of 17.1±0.15 MPa and
16.5±0.17 MPa, respectively. The highest strength value (17.1 MPa from sample ZX) is almost
twice of the lowest one (8.8 MPa from sample XZ).
5Figure 4.21b also shows the apparent tensile strength if an isotropic rock is assumed for all the
sample groups. The X plane remains the weakest plane to split and Z plane stays the strongest.
However, with the isotropic model, sample XY has the lowest tensile strength of 10.3 MPa,
rather than sample XZ (8.8 MPa) from the orthotropic model; sample ZX remains to be the
toughest to split but the strength value drops from 17.1 MPa (5Figure 4.21a) to 15.5 MPa ( 5Figure
4.21b). In addition, the ratio of the highest tensile strength to the lowest one decreases to 1.50
with isotropic model. The ineligible discrepancy between those two treatments reveals that the
consideration of the material anisotropic elasticity is necessary for tensile strength determination
of anisotropic granite. Therefore, the material anisotropic elasticity of Barre granite is considered
for both static and dynamic data analyses.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 87
(a)
(b)
XY XZ YX YZ ZX ZY0
4
8
12
16
Anisotropic Model
16.517.1
11.813.0
8.8
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
9.5
XY XZ YX YZ ZX ZY0
4
8
12
16 15.315.5
12.912.5
10.610.3
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
Isotropic Model
Figure 4.21 The variation of static tensile strength of Barre granite along six directions, i.e. XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY, using (a) orthotropic model (b) isotropic model.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 88
4.4.2.3 Dynamic tensile strength anisotropy
All the tensile strength values with corresponding loading rates are tabulated in 5Table 4.2.
Table 4.2 Tensile strengths of Barre granite along six directions from both static and
dynamic Brazilian tests.
XY XZ
No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa) No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa)
1 1.8E-04 9.4 1 1.7E-04 8.9 2 1.8E-04 9.4 2 1.7E-04 8.7 3 1.8E-04 9.7 3 1.7E-04 8.8 4 239.6 19.2 4 175.0 15.1 5 458.5 24.9 5 355.4 21.3 6 745.5 29.2 6 746.7 25.0 7 876.6 32.3 7 845.0 28.6 8 1261.8 34.0 8 1197.4 31.3 9 1480.1 37.7 9 1339.8 34.7
10 1550.0 38.2 10 1558.9 36.6
YX YZ
No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa) No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa)
1 2.1E-04 13.2 1 1.8E-04 11.8 2 2.1E-04 12.9 2 1.8E-04 12.0 3 2.1E-04 12.9 3 1.8E-04 11.6 4 303.1 24.4 4 200.4 19.3 5 371.2 27.3 5 433.7 26.2 6 591.0 31.2 6 735.3 30.5 7 867.5 33.3 7 896.0 34.6 8 1226.4 37.6 8 1222.1 33.8 9 1400.2 38.9 9 1498.0 38.7
10 1617.6 40.9 10 1801.1 41.7
ZX ZY
No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa) No. σ& (GPa/s) tσ (MPa) 1 2.2E-04 17.2 1 2.1E-04 16.4 2 2.2E-04 16.9 2 2.1E-04 16.7 3 2.2E-04 17.1 3 2.1E-04 16.4 4 243.3 28.4 4 236.9 24.9 5 332.1 32.1 5 540.2 33.1 6 656.4 35.6 6 630.8 34.8 7 988.6 38.0 7 892.8 36.4 8 1698.5 44.9 8 1171.5 41.8 9 1281.1 45.1 9 1816.2 44.4
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 89
5Figure 4.22 illustrates the variation of strength values with loading rates. Within the range of
loading rates available, the tensile strength increases with the loading rate for each of the six
sample groups in a non-linear manner. There seems to be a transition of loading rate sensitivity
at the loading rate of 500 GPa/s. The rock tensile strength is more rate-sensitive when it is loaded
below this transition loading rate. The reason for this transition is not clear, however, similar
trend was found in the literature (Cai et al., 2007).
It is also observed from 5Figure 4.22 that the splitting plane of the disc (the first index in the
sample terminology) has the dominant influence on the tensile strength while the fracture
propagation direction (the second index in the sample terminology) only has a slight influence.
In view of this, all the results are sorted into three groups according to three different splitting
planes normal to X axis (sample XY and XZ), Y axis (sample YX and YZ) and Z axis (sample
ZX and ZY).
0 500 1000 1500
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
ZX ZY YX YZ XY XZ
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 4.22 The variation of tensile strength with loading rates for six sample groups of Barre granite.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 90
Within these three groups, the ratio of the maximum tensile strength to the minimum tensile
strength is defined as the anisotropic index of tensile strength, denoted as tα . The strength values
for all three splitting planes are shown in 5Figure 4.23a, b and c.
400 800 1200 1600
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
X Plane (XY & XZ)
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
400 800 1200 1600
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
Z Plane (ZX & ZY)
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
400 800 1200 1600
15
20
25
30
35
40
45
Y Plane (YX & YZ)
Tens
ile s
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
(a)
(c)
(b)
(d)
0 400 800 1200 1600
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
α t
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 4.23 The tensile strength with loading rates for samples splitting in the plane normal to (a) X axis (b) Y axis (c) Z axis; and (d) the tensile strength anisotropic index (αt) of Barre granite with loading rates.
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 91
The samples with splitting plane normal to Z axis owns the highest values of tensile strength
while samples with splitting plane normal to X axis yields the lowest. The variation of the
anisotropic index of tensile strength tα with loading rates is shown in 5Figure 4.23d. For the
static case, αt equals to 1.83, with the highest strength of 16.8 MPa for samples splitting in the
plane normal to Z axis; and the lowest of 9.2 MPa with splitting plane normal to X axis.
Compared to the static one, the dynamic tensile strength anisotropy is much lower. For example,
under the loading rate around 200 GPa/s, sample with splitting plane normal to Z axis owes the
highest tensile strength of 28.9 MPa and splitting plane normal to X axis shows the lowest value
of 18.9 MPa, and αt is 1.53. As the loading rate is around 1800 GPa /s, αt is about 1.13 and the
maximum tensile strength still occurs in samples with splitting plane normal to Z with a value of
47.3 MPa and the lowest one is fixed in samples split in plane normal to X axis as 41.7 MPa.
Barre granite obviously exhibits stronger anisotropy under static loading than the counterpart
under dynamic loading. In addition, the αt curve in 5Figure 4.23d drops quickly approaching the
isotropic value of 1. This implies that under very high loading rates (e. g. shock wave loading),
the tensile strength anisotropy may disappear.
4.4.3 Interpretation of the Results
The main purpose of the study is to characterize the microcrack induced tensile strength
anisotropy of Barre granite under both static and dynamic loading conditions. As shown in
5Figure 4.23d, Barre granite exhibits strong anisotropy under static loading. This tensile strength
anisotropy is mainly attributed to the preferred distribution and orientation of microcracks sets.
Douglass and Voight (1969) studied the microcrack orientation in Barre granite and
demonstrated that a strong concentration of microcracks lies within the rift plane and the
secondary concentration was found within the grain plane. In this study, with reference to the
dominant three sets of microcracks in Figure 3.2 in Chapter 3, YZ plane is recognized to be
parallel to the rift plane with the dominant microcracks, and XZ plane is the secondary
concentration of microcracks for Barre granite. The YZ plane, XZ plane and XY plane
correspond to the quarryman’s description of “rift plane”, “grain plane” and “hard-way plane”
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 92
respectively. This explains that in the static tensile strength measurements, the minimum tensile
strength is obtained from sample XY and XZ, both split in the rift plane YZ (normal to X axis);
while the maximum are obtained from sample ZX and ZY with a hard-way splitting plane XY
(normal to Z axis). The relationship of the microcracks induced tensile strength anisotropy with
the principal directions is also consistent with those reported by Goldsmith et al. (1976), who
used orientation 2 (maximum static Young’s modulus), orientation 3 (minimum static Young’s
modulus) and orientation 1 (intermediate static Young’s modulus) to denote the three orthogonal
planes in Barre granite. In my notation, direction 1 is Y, direction 2 is Z, and direction 3 is X.
Under dynamic loading, the anisotropy of tensile strength is much lower than that under static
loading. The anisotropic index of tensile strength drops drastically from the static value of 1.83
to the dynamic value of 1.13 with a loading rate of 1800 GPa/s. The tensile strength anisotropy
of Barre granite appears to be sensitive under quasi-static loading while rather insensitive under
dynamic loading rates. Similar phenomenon has also been observed by Kipp et al. (1980) on a
fine-grained sedimentary rock, oil shale, which also has a pre-existing flaw structure. They found
that in oil shale, the static fracture stress is on the order of 5~20 MPa, quite sensitive to the
loading orientation relative to the bedding planes (Schmidt, 1977); in contrast, the fracture stress
at strain rates from 104 s-1 to 105 s-1 (on the order of 100 MPa, obtained by spalling tests) is
insensitive to orientations (Grady and Hollenbach, 1979).
When a rock sample with an array of cracks is loaded statically, the critical flaw or crack will
dominate the response of the rock, yielding the maximum bearing load. If a preferred orientation
of the largest flaws exists, the material will also show a dependence on the orientation for the
fracture stress (Kipp et al., 1980). For tension tests on six groups of Barre granite samples, the
splitting direction (normal to the loading direction) with the most microcracks (i.e., X direction)
thus has the smallest strength while the direction with the least microcracks (i.e., Z direction) has
the largest strength. In sharp contrast, under dynamic loading, however, the critical flaw no
longer dominates; rather, myriads of pre-existed cracks with a wide range of sizes are activated
nearly simultaneously. Thus, the material is fractured into more pieces through multiple crack
growth. Even with some preferred flaws/microcracks orientation, the dynamic fracture stress
tends to be independent of orientation (Kipp et al., 1980). Hence, the anisotropic property of
Barre granite due to the presence of preferred microcracks has less influence on the dynamic
catastrophic failure. In addition, based on their study, Kipp et al. (1980) found the insensitivity of
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 93
the fracture stress over a large range of crack sizes, which suggests that the inherent flaws in the
rock are the basis for the rate dependence of fracture stress, i.e., it is a geometric but not a
material effect (Kipp et al., 1980, Grady and Kipp, 1980). Thus, the effects of anisotropy on the
tensile strength of Barre granite are overshadowed by this dynamic effect.
The dynamic load is qualitatively very different from static load. Although in the case the sample
is essentially loaded under a quasi-static condition, it takes time for the load to reach a certain
level and this time is shorter for a faster loading case. As a result, only a small volume V of the
sample is indeed stressed to a high value during such a short time and this volume is not affected
by its neighboring small volumes. Since crack densities are quite different for various
orientations, and because cracks interact more when aligned in the same plane, for a given small
volume V, the number of “strongly interactive” cracks will be different for the three orientations.
When V decreases, the number of “strongly interactive” cracks may decrease more for a low
crack density orientation than for a high crack density orientation (clustering effect). This will
lead to less anisotropy for dynamic rock tensile strength.
4.5 Summary
In this Chapter, a dynamic Brazilian test with SHPB system is proposed to measure the dynamic
tensile strength of rocks. A simple quasi-static data reduction method similar to the static
standard Brazilian method is used to calculate the strength which assumes a quasi-static stress
state dominates the dynamic test.
To validate this method, two types of dynamic tests were conducted: 1) non-pulse shaped
incident loading wave featuring a rectangular shape; 2) carefully pulse shaped incident wave
with a ramped shape. It was observed with the aid of a high speed camera that in a pulse shaped
SHPB test, the splitting of the disc starts approximately from the centre. This is not the case for
tests without pulse shaping. The usage of static analysis of dynamic BD tests given dynamic
force balance is then further examined. It is demonstrated that with dynamic force balance
achieved by the pulse shaping technique, the peak of the far-field load synchronizes with the
CHAPTER 4: DYNAMIC TENSION TESTS 94
fracture time of the crack gauge at the disc centre and the time-varying dynamic forces on both
ends of the sample are almost identical. Furthermore, the evolutions of dynamic compressive
stress and tensile stress at the centre of the disc obtained from the dynamic finite element
analysis agree with those from quasi-static analysis.
These results fully verified that with dynamic force balance in SHPB, the inertial effect is
minimized for samples with complex geometries like Brazilian disc. The dynamic force balance
thus enables the regression of tensile strength from dynamic Brazilian test using quasi-static
approach. To conclude, the dynamic tensile strength of rocks measured using SHPB are reliable
with careful experimental implementations.
The dynamic Brazilian test is then applied to investigate the tensile strength of anisotropic Barre
granite. Rate dependence of the tensile strength of Barre granite has been observed along all six
directions. The Barre granite exhibits strong tensile strength anisotropy under static loading
while diminishing anisotropy in dynamic loading. Under high loading rates, it is anticipated that
the tensile strength anisotropy can be ignored and the dynamic tensile strength appear to be
isotropic. The reason for the tensile strength anisotropy may be understood using the microcracks
orientations and the rate dependence of the anisotropy is explained with the microcracks
interaction.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 95
CHAPTER 5
DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS
In this chapter, a dynamic semi-circular bend (SCB) flexural testing method is proposed to
measure the flexural strength of rocks with split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system. To
validate the dynamic flexural testing method, both traditional SHPB and pulse shaped SHPB
tests are conducted using isotropic Laurentian granite; and the data reduction method is
critically assessed. This method is then adopted to investigate the loading rate dependence of
flexural strength anisotropy of Barre granite. The result is then interpreted. The flexural strength
is consistently higher than the tensile strength by Brazilian test for all directions; and this has
been interpreted with a non-local failure approach.
5.1 Background studies
As stated in the previous chapter, although direct tensile or pull test has been a natural approach
for measuring the tensile strength of brittle solids like rocks, the stress concentration due to the
sample gripping often induces damage near sample ends, causing its pre-mature failure and
deviation from the desired uniaxial stress state. In addition, bending in direct tensile tests due to
imperfections in the sample preparation and misalignment makes it difficult to interpret the
testing results (Coviello et al., 2005). Consequently, indirect methods have been developed to
determine the tensile strength of rocks. Examples are Brazilian disc (BD) test (Bieniawski and
Hawkes, 1978; Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), ring test
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 96
(Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson et al., 1972; Mellor and Hawkes, 1971), and bending test
(Coviello et al., 2005).
Apart from the Brazilian tests, the tensile strength can also be measured from bending tests
(Coviello et al., 2005). Generally, the tensile strength measured from a bending configuration is
termed flexural strength. This test aims at generating tensile stress at a critical point in the
sample with bending configuration by far-field compression, which is also much easier in
instrumentation than direct tensile tests. The apparent merit of the bending tests over the other
indirect tension methods is that the tensile stress at the failure point of the bending tests is pure
uni-axial, while all other indirect tests, the stress state at the failure spot is bi-axial. Bending of
one dimensional specimens (i.e. beams with circular or rectangular cross section) is very popular
in many branches of civil engineering (Coviello et al., 2005). Three points bending (3PB) and
four points bending (4PB) tests are adopted as a standard for determining the flexural strength of
materials such as natural and artificial building stones, rocks, cement and concrete (ASTM C99 /
C99M-09, 2009; ASTM C880 / C880M-09, 2009; ASTM Standard C78-09, 2009; ASTM
Standard C293-07, 2007; BS EN 12372, 1999; BS EN 13161, 2008). For example, there are two
ASTM standards to guide the testing of flexural strength of concrete. One is ASTM standard
C293 using central point loading. As schematically shown in 5Figure 5.1a, the entire load is
applied at the center of the span; and the maximum tensile stress only occurs at the center of the
span (ASTM Standard C293-07, 2007). The other standard is ASTM Standard C78 with four
points loading, as 5Figure 5.1b depicts. In this method, half of the load is applied upon each third
of the span length and the maximum tensile stress is present over the center one third portion of
the span. For both methods, the critical tensile strength causing the failure of the beam is the
flexural strength (ASTM Standard C78-09, 2009).
The 3PB and 4PB tests have been used by researchers to measure the nominal tensile strength or
flexural strength of rocks; and it has been found that the measured tensile strength from bending
tests, or flexural strength is generally higher than the tensile strength measured from direct pull
or Brazilian tests under quasi-static loading cases (Coviello et al., 2005), even under fast
loadings cases with a modified material testing machine (Zhao and Li, 2000).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 97
Figure 5.1 Schematics of the determination of the flexural strength of concrete by ASTM standards: a) ASTM C293, i.e. center point loading; the entire load is applied at the center of the span. The maximum tensile stress only occurs at the center of the span; b) ASTM C78, i.e. four points loading; half of the load is applied upon each third of the span length. Maximum tensile stress is present over the center 1/3 portion of the span.
The only paper available in the literature on the dynamic bending tests of rocks is that by Zhao
and Li (2000), who tested the dynamic flexural properties of a granite with three point bending
techniques. The loading was driven by air and oil, and thus the highest loading rate they reached
is rather limited. To characterize dynamic flexural strength under higher loading rates, the
bending tests are adopted on the split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 98
It is well known that for dynamic tests, there is an inertial effect caused by dynamic stress wave
loading. The pulse shaping technique in SHPB (Frew et al., 2002; Frew et al., 2005; Song and
Chen, 2004) can facilitate dynamic force balance and thus reduce the inertial effect, but the
extent of such reduction is not adequately examined. To justify the quasi-static assumption for
reducing the data from indirect dynamic tensile tests with SHPB, two conditions remain to be
verified rigorously: the dynamic stress equilibrium in the sample and the synchronization of the
peak loading with the rupture onset. For dynamic compressive or direct tension testing, the
samples are cylindrical and thus the force balance on the ends ensures the stress equilibrium
throughout the sample (Frew et al., 2001). However, the samples used for indirect dynamic
tensile testing are two dimensional (2D); force balance on the boundaries does not necessarily
ensure stress equilibrium within the entire sample. One needs to compare the stress history at a
chosen point obtained from full dynamic analysis with that from quasi-static analysis. In the
quasi-static analysis, the peak load is used to calculate the flexural strength. Examining the
match in time between the loading peak and the rupture onset is thus also necessary.
It is intented to develop and validate an applicable method for characterizing the dynamic
flexural strength of rocks and potentially for other brittle solids: semi-circular bending (SCB)
testing with a modified SHPB system. The SCB method has been developed for tensile strength
measurements under quasi-static conditions (Aravani and Ferdowsi, 2006), and this concept is
adopted in our dynamic SHPB testing. It is a convenient alternative to the Brazilian test method,
and it has certain advantages including convenience in sample preparation and less stress
concentration at the contact points. For brittle solids such as rocks, the sample is susceptible to
damage induced by sample preparation. For example, the rocks are normally sampled as
cylindrical cores, thus favoring current SCB method and the Brazilian disk tests. However,
traditional three-point bend tests use rectangular samples. Furthermore, the failure force required
in a SCB test is much less than the Brazilian disk tests for a given material. Consequently, the
stress concentration at the contacts, which may lead to inaccuracy in the measurements, is less
for SCB. In addition, for dynamic tests, it is commonly believed that it takes several round trips
of a wave in the sample before the stress reaches the equilibrium state (Song and Chen, 2004).
Shorter samples are used in the SCB tests than in the Brazilian disk tests. Hence for a given
sample diameter, it is easier to achieve the desired equilibrium state in SCB tests.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 99
This chapter is organized as follows. Section 5.2 presents the methodology including the
modified SHPB system, SCB testing and finite element analysis, followed by the rigorous
evaluation of the proposed dynamic SCB flexural testing method in Section 5.3. Section 5.4
presents the flexural strength results of anisotropic Barre granite along six different directions;
and the consistent higher measures of the flexural strength to the tensile strength characterized in
the preceding chapter are interpreted using a non-local failure approach. Section 5.5 summarizes
the whole work in this chapter.
5.2 Dynamic Semi-circular Bend Flexural Test
5.2.1 The Semi-circular Bend Testing in a SHPB System
The SCB method has been developed for flexural strength measurements under quasi-static
conditions (Aravani and Ferdowsi, 2006), and this concept is adopted in our dynamic SHPB
testing. The SCB testing in the SHPB system and the sample geometry are schematically shown
in 5Figure 5.2. The curved end of the specimen is in tangential contact with the incident bar, and
the flat end is in contact with the transmitted bar through two supporting pins separated by a
distance of S = 21.8 mm. Upon impact, bending and fracture are induced in the specimen. As
introduced in Chapter 3, the SCB samples for both Laurentian granite and Barre granite are
prepared accordingly, with a nominal radius of R = 20 mm and average thickness of B = 16 mm.
In order to determine the rupture initiation instant, tm, a strain gauge is mounted on the surface of
the specimen L = 4 mm away from the center O where the maximum tensile stress occurs and
thus the rupture initiates (5Figure 5.2). tm is signaled by a rapid drop in strain (Weisbrod and Rittel,
2000). The travel time of the unloading wave from the failure spot O to the strain gauge is ∆t.
Then the rupture instant follows as tr = tm − ∆t, where ∆t = L /c and c is the material wave speed.
The determination of rupture instant via strain gauge is only for evaluation purpose in Section
5.3.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 100
P1P2/2
B
R
S
Strain gauge
P2/2Failure spot
Figure 5.2 Schematic of the semi-circular bending (SCB) testing in a SHPB system. The semi-circular specimen, with a thickness B = 16 mm and radius R = 20 mm, is sandwiched between the incident and transmitted bars. A strain gauge is mounted on the specimen near the point O.
5.2.2 Determination of Flexural Strength
It still remains a challenge to measure in situ the full field stress history in the specimen. One
practical way yet with reasonable accuracy is to measure the far-field loading and then input it
into a finite element analysis to deduce the stress in the tested sample. Both quasi-static and
dynamic finite element analyses are feasible. The finite element analysis is performed with
ANSYS. Taking advantage of the specimen symmetry in our SCB tests, only half of the
specimen is necessary for constructing the finite element model. Quadrilateral eight-node
element PLANE82 is used in the analysis, and the finite element model consists of 2357
elements and 7252 nodes in total (5Figure 5.3).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 101
Figure 5.3 Meshing scheme of the SCB specimen for finite element analysis. F1 and F2 denote forces applied on the contact points.
For quasi-static analysis, the forces are equal, i.e., F1=F2=P(t)/2. The tensile stress σs(t) history
near the failure spot O can be determined as:
)2
()()(RSY
BRtPts ⋅=
πσ . (5.1)
where P(t) is assumed to be the transmitted force (P2) deduced from the SCB-SHPB tests. Y is a
function of the dimensionless geometry parameter S/2R, which needs to be calibrated with static
finite element analysis. 5Figure 5.4 shows Y as a function of S/2R calculated from the finite
element analysis, and a polynomial fitting yield:
2)2
(54.4)2
(87.222.2RS
RSY ++= . (5.2)
The coefficient of determination R2 is 0.9999 for the fitting curve in Equation 5.2 (Figure 5.4).
For our configuration, S/2R = 0.5461 and Y = 5.132.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 102
0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.03
4
5
6
7
8
9 Data Fitting curve
Y
S/2R
R = 0.99992
Figure 5.4 Y as a function of the dimensionless geometry parameter S/2R from the quasi-static finite element analysis; the coefficient of determination of the fitting curve R2 is 0.9999.
The dynamic flexural strength (σf) within the quasi-static analysis can then be calculated with the
peak value in the measured loading history (Pmax) as:
)2
(max
RSY
BRP
f ⋅=π
σ (5.3)
The dynamic finite element analysis is conducted to obtain the elastodynamic response of the
SCB specimen. Assuming linear elasticity, this analysis solves the following equation of motion
with the Newmark time integration technique (Weisbrod and Rittel, 2000):
u&&ρ=⋅∇ σ (5.4)
where σ is the stress tensor, ρ denotes density, and u&& is the second time derivative of
displacement vector u. The input loads F1 and F2 are taken as half of the dynamic loading forces
exerted on the incident side and transmitted side of the specimen, respectively, i.e., F1 =P1/2 and
F2 =P2/2.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 103
5.3 Validation of Semi-Circular Bend Tests
5.3.1 Failure Sequences of the Specimen in the Dynamic SCB Test
To visualize the dynamic fracture process of SCB rock specimen, a Photron Fastcam SA1 high
speed camera is utilized to monitor the dynamic SCB test on Laurentian granite. The high speed
camera is placed perpendicular to the sample surface with images taken at an inter frame interval
of 8 μs. Frames with representative features are illustrated in 5Figure 5.5.
Figure 5.5 High-speed video images of a dynamic semi-circular bend test on Laurentian
granite.
After around 170 μs, the newly generated cracks of the SCB sample become visible. This
macroscopic crack initiates from the failure spot O (5Figure 5.2), where the tensile stress is the
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 104
maximum. After that, the macroscopic crack propagates to the incident bar end of the sample
along the loading axis, resulting in the final catastrophic failure of the SCB sample. The fracture
pattern of the recovered SCB sample for this test is shown in the last frame of 5Figure 5.5. This
shows that the primary failure of the SCB test is tensile and the failure indeed starts from the
failure spot O, where the tensile stress is the largest.
5.3.2 Dynamic SCB Test without Pulse Shaping
The results and discussions of post-mortem examination and strain (stress) histories deduced
from the strain gauge measurements on the incident and transmitted bars and on the specimen,
and from the finite element analysis are presented below.
5Figure 5.6 shows two recovered samples from the SCB tests in the SHPB system without pulse
shaping [5Figure 5.6a] and with proper pulse shaping [5Figure 5.6b].
Figure 5.6 Samples recovered from the SCB testing on Laurentian granite in a SHPB system (a) without pulse shaping, and (b) with pulse shaping; each division in the scale denotes 1 mm.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 105
Both samples are split cleanly into two halves without noticeable damage at the three loading
points. The fracture pattern indicates that the principal crack initiates from the failure spot O of
the sample as expected. Note that both samples are subjected to single-pulse loading with the
momentum trap technique, which prevents further damage to the sample due to multiple loading
pulses (Xia et al., 2008).
5Figure 5.7, 5Figure 5.8 and 5Figure 5.9 show the results for the SCB test without pulse shaping.
The direct SHPB measurements include the force histories for the incident, reflected and
transmitted waves ( 5Figure 5.7). The rising time is about 20µs, and the pulse width is about 140
µs for the incident wave. In order to check whether the force balance is achieved between both
ends of the specimen, the force on the transmitted side (P2) is compared to the force on the
incident side (P1); the latter shows pronounced fluctuations, and the force balance is not achieved
during the whole loading duration.
Figure 5.7 Force histories on both ends of the specimen in the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite without pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 106
Figure 5.8 Tensile stress histories at the failure spot O of the Laurentian granite specimen from the dynamic finite element and quasi-static analyses for the SCB-SHPB test without pulse shaping.
Figure 5.9 Strain gauge signal and the transmitted force P2 in the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite without pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 107
Using the forces (stress) history on both ends of the sample acquired from the test without pulse
shaping as the inputs to the dynamic finite element analysis, the stress histories at the failure spot
O are obtained. This is then compared with that from quasi-static analyses where the transmitted
force is used as loading input (5Figure 5.8). The former shows more pronounced fluctuations than
the latter, and the agreement between them is poor. Because the dynamic finite element analysis
represents the real stress history, the quasi-static analysis with the far-field loading as input can
not adequately represent the stress history in the sample without force balance.
The peak value of P2(t) is normally taken as Pmax for static analysis to calculate the material
tensile strength [Equation. (5.3)] (Wang et al., 2006). Therefore, the onset instant of fracture as
identified from the strain gauge history recorded on the specimen should coincide
(approximately) with the peak instant of P2(t) after appropriate time corrections as discussed
above. 5Figure 5.9 shows the comparison between these two histories. Two troughs are visible
from the stain gauge signal. The first trough occurs at about 39 µs and the second at 68 µs. The
second (lower) trough is believed to be indicative of the rupture onset. The peak of P2 occurs at
96 µs, delayed by 28 µs with respect to the rupture onset. This is apparently caused by the
inertial effect in the specimen due to the stress wave loading. As a result of the inertial effect, the
far-field load P2 does not synchronize with the local load at point O (5Figure 5.8). The failure
occurs once the local stress reaches the material strength and thus its onset can be earlier than the
peak of the far-field load P2. Therefore, the flexural stress in the sample cannot be deduced from
far-field measurement via quasi-static analysis, i.e., the quasi-static analysis is not valid for
deducing the flexural strength in the SCB-SHPB experiments if the far-field dynamic force
balance is not achieved.
5.3.3 Dynamic SCB Test with Careful Pulse Shaping
For the SHPB test with proper pulse shaping ( 5Figure 5.10, 5Figure 5.11 and 5Figure 5.12), the
results are in sharp contrast to those from the test without pulse shaping. The incident wave is
shaped to a ramp pulse with a rising time of 150 µs, and a total pulse width of 300 µs. The force
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 108
balance is fully achieved on both ends of the sample before the peak is reached in the incident
pulse, since the pre-peak forces on both sides of the samples are almost identical (5Figure 5.10).
Figure 5.10 Demonstration of dynamic force equilibration on both ends of the specimen in the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite with appropriate pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 109
Figure 5.11 Tensile stress histories at the specimen failure spot from dynamic and quasi-static finite element analyses for the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite with appropriate pulse shaping.
Figure 5.12 Strain gauge signal and the transmitted force P2 in the SCB-SHPB test on Laurentian granite with pulse shaping.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 110
With the measured forces as inputs, the tensile stress histories for dynamic and quasi-static finite
element analyses (5Figure 5.11) are found to agree with each other. 5Figure 5.12 compares the
strain signal from the gauge mounted on the specimen and the transmitted force P2 measured by
the SHPB system. The single trough registered by the strain gauge on the specimen occurs at
174.3 µs, indicating the onset of the rupture. The peak of P2 occurs at 176.1 µs, with a delay of
only 1.8 µs relative to the rupture initiation. This small difference can be understood as follows.
The load on the SCB specimen increases with the incident pulse before it reaches the peak. At
the onset of rupture, release waves are emitted from point O. These waves travel at the sound
speed of the rock material. The distance between point O and the supporting pin is 10.9 mm and
it thus takes around 2.2 µs for the first release wave to reach the supporting pins. Due to the
interaction between the release wave and the pins, the load on the transmitted side decreases
despite that the load in the incidence pulse is still rising (5Figure 5.10). Furthermore, the measured
peak transmitted force is 6.628 kN, only 0.2% higher than the force of 6.615 kN at the rupture
initiation time. Thus, the single trough in the strain gauge signal (the rupture onset) can be
regarded as synchronous with the peak of the transmitted force.
The measured flexural strength in the dynamic SCB test with proper pulse shaping is calculated
to be 34.1 MPa at a loading rate of 373 GPa/s. The loading rate is calculated by fitting the linear
portion of the tensile stress evolution. The dynamic flexural strength of Laurentian granite has
not been reported before. The dynamic flexural strength of another type of granite measured with
the three point bending technique ranges from 20 MPa to 30 MPa (Zhao and Li, 2000). Our
result is higher than those by Zhao and Li (2000). This is because the highest loading rate they
achieved is only 10 GPa/s, an order of magnitude lower than ours. The higher value of the
flexural strength in our experiments is expectedly due to the loading rate effect on flexural
strength.
The above results demonstrate that in a modified SHPB test with proper pulse shaping, the
dynamic force balance within the sample is achieved. Thus, the tensile stress state at the failure
spot O in the sample can be calculated with either quasi-static analysis or dynamic finite element
analysis using the far-field measurements as inputs. Moreover, the rupture time synchronizes
with the peak of the transmitted pulse recorded in the SHPB system after corrections for travel
time. Therefore, the dynamic flexural strength can be calculated from the peak of the transmitted
wave measured in the SHPB system with quasi-static analysis.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 111
The dynamic SCB technique allows indirect tensile testing with a well established dynamic
compression setup. Despite the 2D configuration in the SCB testing, it is highly feasible to
achieve stress equilibrium and the synchronization of the rupture onset with the peak of the
transmitted pulse in rocks as shown above, and the simple quasi-static analysis is valid for data
reduction. This method is thus an efficient way of determining the dynamic flexural strength in
brittle solids like rocks.
5.4 Flexural Strength of Barre Granite
5.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Flexural Strength
5.4.1.1 Stress distribution in the disc sample
Static measurement is conducted with an MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system ( 5Figure
5.13a). Dynamic test is conducted using a 25 mm SHPB system ( 5Figure 5.13b). The specimen is
sandwiched between the incident and transmitted bars. The dynamic forces on both ends of the
sample P1 and P2 are recorded by the two strain gauges mounted on the incident bar and
transmission bar, respectively.
Let x, y, z be a global Cartesian coordinate system shown in 5Figure 5.13, the y-axis defines the
loading direction and the z-axis denotes the axial direction of the disc. In the quasi-static elastic
equilibrium, the components of the stress tensor for any point (x, y) in the disc can be expressed
as follows:
xxx qRBP
⋅=π
σ , yyy qRBP
⋅=π
σ , xyxy qRBP
⋅=π
τ (5.5)
where σx, σy and τxy are three components of the stress tensor and qxx, qyy and qxy are the
corresponding components of the dimensionless stress tensor and can be calculated using
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 112
numerical tools according to Equation (5.6). Compression is positive in the following
calculations.
RBP
q xxx
π
σ= ,
RBP
q yyy
π
σ= ,
RBP
q xyxy
π
τ= (5.6)
(a)
P1P2/2
B
R
S
P2/2
P
P/2
B
R
SP/2
o
Incident Bar Transmitted Bar
(b)
x
yx
y
o
Figure 5.13 Schematics of the semi-circular bend test in (a) the material testing machine and (b) the SHPB system.
To measure the flexural strength of anisotropic rocks by SCB test, a thorough analysis of the
stress state in the anisotropic disc is required to deduce the calculating equation. In this work,
finite element analysis using ANSYS is conducted to analyze the stress state in the anisotropic
Barre granite half disc for all our six types of SCB sample configurations. Quadrilateral eight-
node element PLANE82 is used in the analysis, and the finite element model consists of 11,397
elements and 34,592 nodes in total. Same as adopted in the previous Chapter 4, Barre granite is
considered orthotropic and the nine stiffness constants Cijkl has also been documented (Sano et al.,
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 113
1992). For comparing purpose, the stress state of the SCB half disc is also analyzed assuming
that the rock is isotropic.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
3
2
1
0 0
-1-2
-3
-1-2
-3
0 0
1 1
2 2
0 0
0
00
0 0
-2
-1
-2 -2
-4-3
-1 -1
-3-3
-4-4
0
0 0
0 0
00
0
2
4
-2
-4
2-2
4-4 -224 -4
0
0
0
0
0 0
11 1
2
3
-3-3-2
-1-2
-1
-1-1
0 0
00
00 0
0 0
-1-1
-2 -2-2-3
-4
-1-3-3
-4 -4
0 0
0
0
00
00
2
2-2
-2
4-4
2 -2-4 4
Figure 5.14 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation. (a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy with isotropic model, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for ZX sample using anisotropic model (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 114
For the isotropic case, 5Figure 5.14a, b and c show the distribution of the dimensionless stress
components qxx, qyy and qxy respectively. The calculated values of qxx, qyy and qxy at the disc centre
of the SCB half disc (potential failure spot) are qxx ~ -5.132, qyy ~ 0 and qxy = 0, respectively. For
anisotropic case, eight sample configurations XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX, and ZY are analyzed; and
similar symmetrical stress contours as the isotropic case have been observed (see, 5Figure 5.15,
5Figure 5.16, 5Figure 5.17 and 5Figure 5.18). As a demonstration, the stress trajectories of the qxx,
qyy and qxy for sample ZX are illustrated in the 5Figure 5.14d to f. The tensile stress distribution
near the centre of the disc is quite uniform for the anisotropic ZX sample (5Figure 5.14d and 4e),
very similar to the isotropic case (5Figure 5.14a and b). The shear stress components (5Figure 5.14f)
along the loading diameter and the horizontal diameter are zero due to the intentional coring and
loading along three predetermined material symmetrical plane X, Y and Z. Therefore, the qxx and
qyy along the loading direction in the 5Figure 5.14d and 5Figure 5.14e acurrately represent the
dimensionless in-plane principal stress σ1 and σ2. 5Figure 5.14e also depicts that the compressive
stress of a point on the diameter of the half disc is zero, which suggests that the stress state at the
failure spot O, i.e. the disc centre, is pure uniaxial tension.
A complete suite of stress trajectories of the qxx, qyy and qxy for semi-circular bend sample under
quasi-static deformation for the isotropic case and six anisotropic sample configurations are
illustrated in 5Figure 5.15, 5Figure 5.16, 5Figure 5.17 and 5Figure 5.18.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 115
(a)
(b)
(c)
Figure 5.15 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation. (a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy with isotropic model.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 116
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 5.16 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation. (a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for XY sample and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for XZ sample (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 117
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 5.17 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation. (a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for YX sample, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for YZ sample (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 118
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Figure 5.18 Stress trajectories of a semi-circular bend sample under quasi-static deformation. (a) qxx, (b) qyy and (c) qxy for ZX sample, and (d) qxx (e) qyy and (f) qxy for ZY sample using anisotropic model (positive for compression, negative for tension).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 119
5.4.1.2 Flexural strength
Using Equation (5.6), the stress state at any point within the disc can be fully determined by the
three dimensionless stress components qxx, qyy and qxy. 5Figure 5.14 shows that for points along
the loading diameter of our anisotropic SCB half disc, the shear stress is zero and the tensile
stress is the highest at the centre of the disc. In addition, the corresponding compressive stress is
also very similar to the isotropic case. The vanishing of the shear stress components along the
loading diameter implies the coincidence of the in-plane principal stress σ1 and σ2 with σx and σy.
For the flexural strength determination for anisotropic Barre granite in this study, a similar
assumption as Chen et al. (1998a) is used that the indirect flexural strength is given by the
maximum absolute value of the tensile stress σx perpendicular to the loading diameter at the disc
centre (maximum local tensile stress):
QBRPf
f ⋅=π
σ (5.7)
where σf is the flexural strength and Pf is the load when the failure occurs. Q is qxx at the centre
of the disc with coordinates (0, 0). Note that at the potential failure spot O, the centre of the disc,
in-plane principal stress σ2 is zero; thus the stress state at O is pure uni-axial tension. For our
configuration, S/2R = 0.5461 and Q = 5.132, for isotropic model, as reported before; and the
calculated dimensionless factors Q for all six sample configurations as well as the material
properties used in the finite element analysis are tabulated in 5Table 5.1.
Table 5.1 The material properties used in the finite element model of SCB samples of Barre
granite along six directions.
Sample Suites
Q
xE (GPa)
yE (GPa)
xyG (GPa)
xyv
XY 5.138 40.7 32.2 15.8 0.093 XZ 5.115 54.8 32.2 17.7 0.105 YX 5.257 32.2 40.7 15.8 0.073 YZ 5.094 54.8 40.7 20.6 0.146 ZX 5.395 32.2 54.8 17.7 0.062 ZY 5.218 40.7 54.8 20.6 0.108
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 120
5.4.2 Flexural Strength Anisotropy
5.4.2.1 Dynamic equilibrium
For SCB tests conducted in the MTS system, the quasi-static Equation (5.3) is accurate while for
dynamic Brazilian tests in the SHPB system, a quasi-static stress state in the sample half disc
during the test has to be checked before Equation (5.3) can be used. This is because the inertial
effect induced in the dynamic tests will lead to errors in data reduction if a quasi-static analysis is
used without justification. In the evaluation of the dynamic SCB method in Section 5.3, it has
been demonstrated that the dynamic forces on both ends of the SCB specimen can effectively
minimize the inertial effect even for complicated sample geometry as SCB (Dai et al., 2008) by
employing pulse shaping technique in SHPB tests (Frew et al., 2002). The quasi-static equation
thus can be used to determine the dynamic flexural strength of rocks (Dai et al., 2010d).
Under these circumstances, in order to guarantee a quasi-static state in the dynamic SCB test and
thus employ the quasi-static equation for data reduction, the time-resolved dynamic forces on
both loading ends of the SCB samples should match and this should be critically assessed for
each test. To do so, pulse shaping technique is employed for all our dynamic tests and the
dynamic force balance on the two loading ends of the sample is compared before data processing.
5Figure 5.19 compares the time-varying forces on both ends of the sample in a typical test on
sample XZ with pulse shaping. It is evident that with pulse shaping (5Figure 5.19), the dynamic
forces on both sides of the samples are almost identical before the maximum loading (i.e. critical
failure point) is reached during the dynamic loading.
Following this strategy, the force balance on both ends of the sample can be guaranteed for all
the dynamic SCB tests. In addition, the momentum trap technique was also applied to all
dynamic tests to ensure single pulse loading pulse to the samples. 5Figure 5.20a and b show the
examples of the virgin SCB samples and recovered samples after tests, respectively. Along the
loading directions, the half disc samples are split into two approximate quarter disc, as shown in
5Figure 5.20b.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 121
Figure 5.19 Dynamic force balance check for a typical dynamic semi-circular bend test on sample XZ of Barre granite with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
(a) (b)
Figure 5.20 (a) Virgin semi-circular bend samples of Barre granite; (b) Recovered semi-circular bend samples of Barre granite after tests.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 122
5.4.2.2 Static flexural strength anisotropy
5Figure 5.21 depicts the variation of static flexural strength measured along six different
directions of Barre granite. For each group, three independent tests have been conducted and the
average strength over the three is taken as the flexural strength for the sample group. The
measured static flexural strength exhibits very strong anisotropy. The average flexural strength
for the two sample configurations with the same splitting plane X (i.e. XY, XZ) yields the lowest
flexural strength of 13.5±0.17 MPa and 12.9±0.25 MPa respectively; configurations with the
splitting plane Y (i.e. YX, YZ) owns intermediate flexural strengths of 17.9±0.17 MPa and 16.4±
0.15 MPa; whereas the configurations with the splitting plane Z (i.e. ZX, ZY) exhibit the highest
strength values of 25.1±0.32 MPa and 24.1± 0.24 MPa, respectively. The highest strength value
(25.1 MPa from sample ZX) is nearly twice of the lowest one (12.9 MPa from sample XZ).
XY XZ YX YZ ZX ZY0
5
10
15
20
25 24.125.1
17.916.4
12.913.5
Flex
ural
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Figure 5.21 The variation of static flexural strength of Barre granite along six directions, i.e. XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 123
5.4.2.3 Dynamic flexural strength anisotropy
All the flexural strength values with corresponding loading rates are tabulated in 5Table 5.2.
5Figure 5.22 illustrates the variation of strength values with loading rates. Within the range of
loading rates available, the flexural strength increases with the loading rate for each of the six
sample groups in a non-linear manner. Similar to the dynamic tensile strength determined from
Brazilian tests in the Chapter 4, there seems to be a transition of loading rate sensitivity at the
loading rate of 500 GPa/s. The rock flexural strength is more rate-sensitive when it is loaded
below this transition loading rate.
0 500 1000 1500 2000
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
ZX SCB ZY SCB YX SCB YZ SCB XY SCB XZ SCB
Flex
ural
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.22 The variation of flexural strength with loading rates along six directions of Barre granite.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 124
5Figure 5.22 further evaluate the same splitting scenario that what is observed in Chapter 4 that
the fracture plane of the disc (the first index in the sample terminology) has a dominant influence
on the flexural strength while the fracture propagation direction (the second index in the sample
terminology) only has a relative slight influence. It is thus logic to divide all the flexural
strengths data points into three groups according to three different splitting planes normal to X
axis (sample XY and XZ), Y axis (sample YX and YZ) and Z axis (sample ZX and ZY),
respectively.
Within these three groups, the ratio of the maximum flexural strength to the minimum flexural
strength can be defined as the anisotropic index of flexural strength, denoted as αf. The flexural
strength values for all three splitting planes are shown in 5Figure 5.23a, b and c. The samples with
splitting plane normal to Z axis own the highest values of flexural strength while samples with
splitting plane normal to X axis yields the lowest. The variation of the anisotropic index of
flexural strength αf with loading rates is shown in 5Figure 5.23d. For the static case, αf equals to
1.86, with the highest strength of 24.6 MPa for samples splitting in the plane normal to Z axis;
and the lowest of 13.2 MPa with splitting plane normal to X axis. Compared to the static one, the
dynamic flexural strength anisotropy is much lower. For example, under the loading rate around
200 GPa/s, sample with splitting plane normal to Z axis owes the highest flexural strength of
41.8 MPa and splitting plane normal to X axis shows the lowest value of 27.0 MPa, and αf is
1.55. As the loading rate is up to 2000 GPa /s, αf is about 1.24 and the maximum flexural
strength still remains in samples with splitting plane normal to Z with a value of 68.9 MPa and
the lowest one is fixed in samples split in the plane normal to X axis as 55.6 MPa.
Thus, Barre granite obviously exhibits stronger anisotropy under static loading, while relatively
lower anisotropy during dynamic loading. In addition, the αf curve in 5Figure 5.23d drops quickly
approaching the isotropic value of 1. This implies that the flexural strength anisotropy may
disappear under very high loading rates (e. g. shock wave loading).
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 125
(a)
(c)
(b)
(d)
0 500 1000 1500 2000
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
α f
Loading rate (GPa/s)
0 500 1000 1500 2000
10
20
30
40
50
60
X Plane (XY & XZ)
Flex
ural
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
0 500 1000 1500 200010
20
30
40
50
60
Y Plane (YX & YZ)
Flex
ural
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
0 500 1000 1500 200020
30
40
50
60
70
Z Plane (ZX & ZY)
Flex
ural
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.23 The flexural strength with loading rates for samples splitting in the plane normal to (a) X axis (b) Y axis (c) Z axis; and (d) The flexural strength anisotropic index (αf) of Barre granite with loading rates.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 126
Table 5.2 Flexural strengths of Barre granite with corresponding loading rates as well as the
non-local reconciliation for both static and dynamic SCB tests.
XY
XZ
No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) 1 ~8E-04 13.3 10.2 1 ~8E-04 13.1 10.1 2 ~8E-04 13.6 10.4 2 ~8E-04 12.6 9.7 3 ~8E-04 13.6 10.4 3 ~8E-04 13.0 10.0 4 418.2 32.2 24.8 4 330.3 25.3 19.5 5 707.6 36.9 28.4 5 450.3 29.7 22.9 6 637.9 38.3 29.4 6 760.6 30.9 23.8 7 727.6 39.9 30.7 7 900.1 35.1 27.0 8 1093.4 43.9 33.7 8 980.7 40.5 31.2 9 1400.7 45.0 34.6 9 1338.2 43.8 33.7
10 1599.3 50.4 38.8 10 1516.2 47.4 36.5 11 1796.9 54.8 42.2 11 1702.2 48.0 36.9
YX YZ
No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) 1 ~8E-04 18.1 13.9 1 ~8E-04 16.5 12.7 2 ~8E-04 17.8 13.7 2 ~8E-04 16.2 12.5 3 ~8E-04 17.8 13.7 3 ~8E-04 16.5 12.7 4 470.1 37 28.5 4 372.2 33.4 25.7 5 676.1 38.1 29.3 5 471.5 33.5 25.8 6 535.7 39.7 30.6 6 491.3 36.2 27.9 7 860.5 47.2 36.3 7 694.8 38.8 29.9 8 1078.6 44.4 34.2 8 992.6 48.8 37.6 9 1382.9 49.7 38.2 9 1470 48.6 37.4
10 1702.1 54.5 41.9 10 1585.2 47.8 36.8 11 2001.3 57.0 43.8 11 2052.5 53.0 40.8
ZX
ZY
No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) No. σ&
(GPa/s) σf
(MPa) σt,N
(MPa) 1 ~8E-04 24.8 17.7 1 ~8E-04 24.4 17.4 2 ~8E-04 25.4 18.1 2 ~8E-04 23.9 17.0 3 ~8E-04 25.1 17.9 3 ~8E-04 24.0 17.1 4 473.1 45.0 32.1 4 386.4 42.0 30.0 5 662.3 45.2 32.3 5 691.4 47.6 34.0 6 620.2 49.4 35.3 6 1016.8 53.5 38.2 7 760.0 53.5 38.2 7 908.0 55.1 39.4 8 998.7 54.5 38.9 8 1300.0 57.0 40.7 9 1061.8 56.4 40.3 9 1118.4 59.0 42.1
10 1314.1 62.1 44.4 10 1525.1 59.9 42.8 11 1926.9 65.9 47.1 11 1700.0 63.2 45.1
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 127
5.4.3 Interpretation of the Results
5.4.3.1 Non-local failure theory
Comparing the flexural strength with SCB method and the tensile strength with BD method, in
several aspects similar scenarios have been evidenced. They are: 1) rate dependence of the
calculated strengths along six sample groups; 2) strong strength anisotropy in the static case; 3)
weak anisotropy in the dynamic case. The interpretation for the rate dependence of flexural
strength anisotropy is the same as that for the tensile strength anisotropy in Chapter 4 in terms of
the microstrucural specifications and thus will not be repeated here.
However, it is noted that the measured flexural strength of Barre granite with the SCB method is
consistently higher than the tensile strength determined with BD method for a given loading rate.
This phenomenon has been observed in the static tensile measurements with a stress gradient
around the potential failure spot (Coviello et al., 2005; Hudson et al., 1972; Lajtai, 1972; Mellor
and Hawkes, 1971). In the tensile property measurement of a granite under intermediate loading
rates, Zhao and Li (2000) also reported the higher value of dynamic tensile strength (i.e. flexural
strength) from their 3-point flexural test as compared to that obtained by BD test. No quantitative
interpretation has been made for this discrepancy.
A non-local approach (Carter, 1992; Lajtai, 1972; Van de Steen and Vervoort, 2001) is utilized
here to reconcile the discrepancy of measured dynamic strengths from SCB and BD tests. Since
the dynamic equilibrium is ensured for all SCB tests, the non-local approach should work for our
dynamic tests. This theory states that the material fails when the local stress averaged over a
distance δ along the prospective fracture path reaches the tensile strength σt (Van de Steen and
Vervoort, 2001):
dll
lt ∫+
= 0
0
δσδσ (5.8)
where δ is designated as an characteristic material length scale and σ is the distribution of the
tensile stress over δ. Numerical method is used here to determine σt for a given sample geometry.
The tensile stress gradient along the prospective fracture path of our SCB sample can be
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 128
calculated numerically with finite element analysis. The polynomial fit of the normalized stress
gradient results in the following equation (see, 5Figure 5.24):
cbxaxm
++= 2
σσ (5.9)
where σ is the tensile stress along the prospective fracture path, σm is the tensile stress at the
failure spot (also the maximum tensile stress in the sample), x is the distance of a point along the
fracture path to the centre of the SCB sample (see the insert in 5Figure 5.24), a, b and c are fitting
factors. If δ is known, substituting Equation (5.9) to Equation (5.8), the ratio κ (i.e. σf /σt)
between flexural strength σf and the resulting tensile strength σt can be determined. On the other
hand, if the ratio κ can be estimated by comparing flexural strength σf to the resulting tensile
strength σt, the characteristic material length δ can be obtained for the material.
Figure 5.24 Normalized tensile stress along the prospective fracture path in a SCB XY sample; x is the distance of a point along the prospective fracture path to the failure spot of the SCB sample (see the insert); the fitting curve has a coefficient of determination R2 of 0.9999.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 129
5.4.3.2 Characteristic material length by matching measures
Take sample group XY for an example to show how to determine the characteristic material
length δ employing non-local failure theory. The tensile stress along the prospective fracture path
in a XY SCB sample can be calculated with finite element analysis and the stress is normalized
with the maximum tensile stress at the potential failure spot O (see, 5Figure 5.24). A polynomial
fit of the normalized stress gradient along the failure path of XY sample yield Equation (5.10):
997.01965.00121.0 2 +−= xxXYm
XY
σσ (5.10)
For sample XY, the ratio κ equal to 1.3, determined by matching the tensile strength with the
reduced strength coming from the flexural strength divided by κ. 5Figure 5.25 shows comparable
strengths of sample XY from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-
local failure model employing a ratio of κ=1.3.
3.1/ == κσσ XYt
XYf (5.11)
Substituting Equation (5.10) into (5.8),
dxxxdx XYXY XYmXYXY
XYt ∫∫ +−==
δδσσδσ
0
2
0)997.01965.00121.0( (5.12)
From Equation (5.11), 3.1/XYf
XYt σσ = , rearranging Equation (5.12),
XYmXYXYXYXY
XYf σδδδδ
σ]997.0)(
21965.0)(
30121.0[
3.123 +−= (5.13)
At failure, XYm
XYf σσ = , thus Equation (5.13) can be further simplified as:
0)3.1
1997.0()(2
1965.0)(3
0121.0 2 =−+− XYXY δδ (5.14)
Solving Equation (5.14), δXY can be calculated as δXY= 2.6 mm.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 130
Following the same strategy, the flexural strengths for all six sample groups of Barre granite are
reconciled. A summary of the results involving the fitting factors a, b and c, the ratio κ and the
determined characteristic length δ are tabulated in 5Table 5.3. 5Figure 5.25~5Figure 5.30 illustrate
both flexural and tensile strengths of sample group XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY of Barre
granite as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model, respectively.
Table 5.3 Summary of the parameters deduced using non-local failure model for all six
sample groups of Barre granite.
Groups a b c κ δ (mm) XY 0.0121 -0.1965 0.9970 1.30 2.6 XZ 0.0110 -0.1875 0.9961 1.30 2.7 YX 0.0149 -0.2188 0.9980 1.30 2.3 YZ 0.0115 -0.1918 0.9973 1.30 2.7 ZX 0.0176 -0.2388 0.9978 1.35 2.5 ZY 0.0148 -0.2185 0.9990 1.35 2.7
0 500 1000 1500 2000
10
20
30
40
50
60
XY SCB XY SCB (Non-local) XY BD
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.25 Comparison of strengths of sample group XY of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 131
0 500 1000 1500
10
20
30
40
50
XZ SCB XZ SCB (Non-local) XZ BD
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.26 Comparison of strengths of sample group XZ of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
0 500 1000 1500 200010
20
30
40
50
60
YX SCB YX SCB (Non-local) YX BD
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.27 Comparison of strengths of sample group YX of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 132
0 500 1000 1500 2000
10
20
30
40
50
YZ SCB YZ SCB (Non-local) YZ BDS
treng
th (M
Pa)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.28 Comparison of strengths of sample group YZ of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
0 500 1000 1500 2000
20
30
40
50
60
70
ZX SCB ZX SCB(Non-local) ZX BD
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.29 Comparison of strengths of sample group ZX of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 133
0 500 1000 1500 2000
20
30
40
50
60
ZY SCB ZY SCB(Non-local) ZY BD
Stre
ngth
(MP
a)
Loading rate (GPa/s)
Figure 5.30 Comparison of strengths of sample group ZY of Barre granite from dynamic SCB test and BD test as well as the reconciliation by non-local failure model.
5.5 Summary
In this chapter, a dynamic flexural strength testing method, the dynamic SCB method is proposed
for measuring the dynamic flexural strength of such brittle solids as rocks. The SCB technique
allows indirect tensile testing with a well established dynamic compression setup. Using a very
simple quasi-static data analysis, the flexural strength of the sample can be deduced.
To evaluate this method, the dynamic SCB tests are performed on Laurentian granite with and
without pulse shaping, and conduct quasi-static and dynamic finite element analyses. A strain
gauge is mounted near the failure spot on the specimen to determine the onset instant of fracture.
It is demonstrated that in a modified SHPB test with proper pulse shaping, the dynamic force
balance within the sample can be achieved. Thus, the tensile stress state at the failure spot O in
the sample can be calculated with either quasi-static analysis or dynamic finite element analysis
CHAPTER 5: DYNAMIC FLEXUAL TESTS 134
using the far-field measurements as inputs. Moreover, the rupture time synchronizes with the
peak of the transmitted pulse recorded in the SHPB system after corrections for travel time.
Therefore, the dynamic flexural strength can be calculated from the peak of the transmitted wave
measured in the SHPB system with quasi-static analysis. This method is thus an efficient way of
determining the dynamic flexural strength in brittle solids.
The dynamic SCB test is then applied to investigate the flexural strength of anisotropic Barre
granite. Rate dependence of the flexural strength of Barre granite has been observed. Similar to
the tensile strength measured from Brazilian tests in the previous chapter, the Barre granite
exhibits strong flexural strength anisotropy under static loading while diminishing anisotropy in
dynamic loading. Under very high loading rates, it is anticipated that the tensile strength
anisotropy disappears.
The reason for the flexural strength anisotropy may be understood using the microcrack
orientations and the rate dependence of the anisotropy is explained with the microcrack
interaction, the same reason as the rate dependence of the tensile strength anisotropy of Barre
granite discussed in Chapter 4. The flexural strengths of Barre granite on all six directions are
consistently higher than the tensile strength measured from Brazilian tests in both static test and
dynamic tests. The tensile stress gradient along the potential failure path is believed to be the
main reason for this distinction, since the tensile strength is defined under a homogeneous tensile
stress state. A non-local failure theory is adopted to qualitatively explain the differences of the
measured strengths; and the gap between the two is bridged as well.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 135
CHAPTER 6
DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS
In this chapter, a dynamic notched semi-circular Bend (NSCB) testing method is proposed to
measure the Mode-I fracture toughness and fracture energy of rocks; and this novel method is
critically assessed using isotropic Laurentian granite. This method is then applied to
investigating the loading rate dependence of Mode-I fracture properties of anisotropic Barre
granite. The rate dependence of the fracture toughness anisotropy is observed and two
conceptual models abstracted from microscopic thin section photos are constructed to
qualitatively reproduce the rate dependence of the fracture toughness anisotropy in terms of the
interaction of the main crack with pre-existing microcracks oriented along preferred different
directions of Barre granite.
6.1 Background Studies
Dynamic fracture plays a vital role in geophysical processes and engineering applications (e.g.,
earthquakes, airplane crashes, projectile penetrations, rock bursts and blasts). Accurate
measurements of dynamic fracture parameters are prerequisite for understanding mechanisms of
fracture and are also useful for engineering applications. For brittle materials such as rocks, one
can not simply use the standard methods of fracture measurement developed for metals. Special
sample geometries have been adopted for fracture toughness measurements of ceramics, rocks
and concretes (Fowell and Xu, 1993; Hanson and Ingraffea, 1997; Ouchterlony, 1989). Various
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 136
methods were proposed in the literature to measure fracture toughness of rocks, including radial
cracked ring (Shiryaev and Kotkis, 1982), notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) (Chong and
Kuruppu, 1984; Lim et al., 1994a; Lim et al., 1994b; Lim et al., 1994c), chevron-notched SCB
(Kuruppu, 1997), Brazilian disc (Guo et al., 1993), and cracked straight through Brazilian disk
(CSTBD) (Atkinson et al., 1982; Chen et al., 1998b; Fowell and Xu, 1994). International Society
of Rock Mechanics (ISRM) proposed short rod (SR) and chevron bending (CB) tests in 1988
(Ouchterlony, 1988) and cracked chevron notched Brazilian disc (CCNBD) in 1995 (Fowell et
al., 1995). All of those specimens are core-based, which facilitate sample preparation from cores
obtained from natural rock masses.
In many mining and civil engineering applications, rocks may be loaded dynamically. By
definition, the dynamic SIF at the fracture onset is the dynamic fracture toughness. Thus, a good
dynamic fracture toughness measurement method should be able to accurately 1) determine the
transient evolution of SIF and 2) detect the fracture initiation time. Unfortunately, the inertial
effect associated with dynamic loading in a dynamic test leads to unreliable data reduction.
Böhme and Kalthoff first showed the inertia effects in dynamic fracture tests (Bohme and
Kalthoff, 1982), where a three point bending configuration was used with the load exerted by a
drop weight. They demonstrated that the measured load histories at the loading point and the two
supporting points did not synchronize with the SIF history of the crack, which was independently
measured with optical method. Tang tried to measure dynamic fracture toughness of rocks by
three point impact using a single Hopkinson bar (Tang and Xu, 1990), and Zhang deployed the
split Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) technique to measure the rock dynamic fracture toughness
with SR specimen (Zhang et al., 2000; Zhang et al., 1999). In these two attempts with Hopkinson
bar, the evolution of SIF and the fracture toughness were calculated using a quasi-static analysis
without careful consideration of the loading inertial effect.
One way to minimize the measurement error induced by the inertial effect is to combine
experiments with full dynamic numerical simulations (Bui et al., 1992; Rittel and Maigre, 1996;
Weisbrod and Rittel, 2000). From the experiments, the loading histories on the sample
boundaries are measured. These data are then used as inputs to a full dynamic numerical code to
determine the local SIF history at the crack tip. A strain gauge or a crack gauge is glued on the
sample close to the initial crack tip to measure the fracture initiation time. The dynamic fracture
toughness is then determined as the SIF at the crack initiation time. This method is rather tedious
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 137
and complicated to apply. An obviously better way to handle the inertial effect is to find a
method to minimize or eliminate it. Without the inertial effect, one can employ quasi-static
analysis to relate the measured far-field loads to the local SIF at the crack tip. Because the static
numerical analysis can be performed beforehand, the material fracture toughness can be then
readily calculated using the peak far-field load.
Recently, a pulse shaping technique in conventional SHPB tests was proposed to facilitate
dynamic force equilibrium and thus eliminate inertial effect for dynamic compressive tests (Frew
et al., 2002; Frew et al., 2005; Song and Chen, 2004). The pulse shaper reduces the slope of the
loading pulse and thus allows more time for a compression sample (cylindrical) to achieve an
almost stress equilibrium state during the loading. Using this technique, Frew et al. obtained the
compressive stress-strain data for a few rocks (Frew et al., 2001). Recently, Owen et al. observed
that the stress intensity factors obtained by directly measuring the crack tip opening are
consistent with those calculated with the quasi-static equation when the dynamic force balance of
the specimen is roughly achieved in the split Hopkinson tension bar testing (Owen et al., 1998).
This concept was further applied to measure the fracture toughness of ceramics using a four-
point bend in SHPB with pulse-shaping (Weerasooriya et al., 2006). However, methods like this
were not fully verified. For cylindrical samples in dynamic compressive tests, the sample stress
state is 1D and thus the force balance at the ends guarantees the equilibrium stress state
throughout the sample. However, samples used for dynamic fracture test have much more
complicated geometry; force balance on the boundary does not necessarily ensure the stress
equilibrium of the entire sample. To fully justify quasi-static analysis for data regression in
dynamic fracture tests using SHPB, one must show the dynamic stress equilibrium in the sample
and the matching of the peak far-field load with the sample fracture onset.
Another important parameter in dynamic fracture is the fracture energy. The fracture energy is
directly related to the energy consumption during dynamic failures. To our best knowledge, there
is only one attempt to measure the dynamic propagation toughness of rocks (Bertram and
Kalthoff, 2003), where an array of strain gauges was used to measure the strain field associated
with fracture propagation. For dynamic fracture, the shrinkage of the domain of small scale
yielding may lead to significant error for methods based only on the singular term of a stress
field (e.g., the strain gauge and caustics methods) (Freund, 1990). Indeed, six terms of expansion
of the stress field is required to fit the photoelastic fringe patterns (Xia et al., 2006).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 138
Fracture energy can be easily measured with optical methods for transparent polymers or
polished metals (Owen et al., 1998; Xia et al., 2006). The concept of optical techniques in SHPB
testing was initiated by Griffith and Martin (1974), who used white light to monitor the
displacements at the end faces of a cylindrical specimen. Tang and Xu measured the crack
surface opening displacement (CSOD) using a line source of white light (Tang and Xu, 1990),
and took the turning point of the CSOD history as the fracture initiation time. Zhang et al. used
the Moiré method to monitor the CSOD of short-rod specimens, and assumed that the peak point
of the opening velocity curve obtained from CSOD corresponds to the onset of fracture (Zhang
et al., 1999). Furthermore, Ramesh and Kelkar adopted a line laser source to measure the
velocity history of flyer in planer impact (Ramesh and Kelkar, 1995). Later, Ramesh and
Narasimhan used this technique to measure the radial expansion of specimens in SHPB tests
(Ramesh and Narasimhan, 1996).
In this work, a new method is proposed to measure the dynamic fracture toughness and fracture
energy of anisotropic Barre granite using the NSCB specimen, loaded dynamically with a
modified SHPB system. Using an isotropic fine-grained granitic rock, Laurentian granite, it is
demonstrated that the dynamic fracture toughness can be calculated by substituting the
experimental measured peak load to the quasi-static equation if the dynamic force balance is
achieved. This method thus provides a useful and cost-effective way to quantify dynamic
fracture toughness of rocks involving Barre granite in particular. For fracture energy
determination, a laser gap gauge (LGG) is used to monitor CSOD of a straight through notched
semi-circular bend (NSCB) specimen during SHPB testing. The residue kinetic energy in the
fragments can be obtained from the fragment velocity, which is the temporal derivative of the
CSOD history. Given the residual fragment kinetic energy and total energy consumption
(deduced from the strain gauge signals), the dynamic fracture energy are determined. A similar
method was attempted by Zhang et al., who used a high-speed camera to estimate the fragment
velocities (Zhang et al., 2000).
This chapter is organized in the following sequence. The overall methodology, including the
experimental setup, the fracture toughness and fracture energy determination are proposed in
Section 6.2. The validation of the dynamic fracture method using a quasi-static data reduction
method is detailed in Section 6.3 using both traditional and pulse shaped SHPB tests. Section 6.4
presents the methodology for calculating anisotropic stress intensity factor and the equation for
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 139
fracture toughness determination; the fracture toughness and fracture energy of anisotropic Barre
granite are measured for all six directions. The rate dependence of fracture toughness anisotropy
is carefully simulated using crack-microcrack models abstracted from microscopic thin section
photography is covered in Section 6.5. Main conclusions are summarized in Section 6.6.
6.2 Dynamic Notched Semi-circular Bend Fracture Test
6.2.1 The Notched Semi-circular Bend Testing in an SHPB System
Dynamic fracture tests on rock materials usually resort to compression-induced tension in order
to avoid failure due to gripping in purely tensile testing. Chong and Kuruppu (1984) adopted a
notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) rock specimen to measure fracture toughness in a
compression setting. This static fracture testing method can be extended to the dynamic tests
with SHPB.
A schematic of the sandwiched NSCB specimen in the SHPB system is shown in 5Figure 6.1, its
radius is R and thickness is B, the depth of the notch is a, and the span of the supporting pins is S.
The force applied on the side without any supporting pins is P1; the force is P2 on the other side
with two pins, with P2/2 is exerted on each pin. 5Figure 6.1 also illustrates the setup of the laser
gap gauge (LGG) system, which is adjusted orthogonal to the sample surface as well as the bar
axis. The LGG is used in the dynamic fracture tests to quantify the flying velocity of the two
cracked half fragments of the NSCB sample, from which the kinetic energy of the fragments can
be calculated.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 140
DetectorGap
Cylindrical lens Sample
Laser
Incident bar Transmitted bar
Collecting lens
Striker
P1 P2a
B
SR
Pulse Shaper Strain Gauge
Figure 6.1 Schematics of the notched semi-circular bend (NSCB) specimen in the spit Hopkinson pressure bar (SHPB) system with laser gap gauge (LGG) system. A strain gauge is mounted on the specimen surface near the crack tip.
6.2.2 Determination of Mode-I Fracture Toughness
A quasi-static data reduction method has been borrowed to determine the Mode-I fracture
toughness of the sample. A complete evaluation of the method is detailed in the Section 6.3.
Referring to ASTM standard E399-06e2 (E399-06e2, 2006), the quasi-static stress intensity
factor (SIF) of the notched SCB specimen is calculated according to the following static equation:
)/,/(2/3 RSRaYBR
SPK I ⋅= (6.1)
where IK is the quasi-static Mode-I SIF, P is the time-varying load, and Y (a/R, S/R) is a
function of the dimensionless crack length a/R and the dimensionless geometrical parameter S/R.
For a given configuration, the numerical value of Y(a/R, S/R) is a constant and is calculated using
the finite element software ANSYS according to Equation (6.2).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 141
2/3
)/,/(
BRSP
KRSRaY I= (6.2)
Due to symmetry, a half-crack model is employed to construct the finite element model.
Quadrilateral eight-node element PLANE82 is used in the analysis. To better simulate the stress
singularity of the crack tip, quarter nodal elements (singular elements) (Barsoum, 1977) are
applied to the vicinity of the crack tip in the mesh of the finite element model (5Figure 6.2b). The
entire model has 2357 elements and 7252 nodes (5Figure 6.2a). For static analysis, the input loads
F1 and F2 equal to half of the transmitted forces recorded in the experiment (i.e., F1= F2 = P2/2).
Symmetry Crack tip
14
34
ω
LGG
Δlv/2
A
F2
F1
(c)
y
x
r
θv
symmetry
(a) (b)
Figure 6.2 Finite element model of the NSCB specimen system (a) the half model of NSCB sample (b) close view of the crack tip mesh (c) crack tip coordinate system.
In the local crack tip coordinate system (5Figure 6.2c), assuming plain strain, the near-tip crack
opening displacement (COD) for a stationary crack under static loading is related to the SIF as:
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 142
ππθ 2)1(8 2
,r
EKvCOD I
r−
== (6.3)
For the half-crack model, the SIF is then determined as:
rvEVK I
π2)1(4 2−
⋅= (6.4)
where V is the half COD determined using Equation (6.3).
Using Equation (6.1), the evolution of the SIF (i.e. KI) in the dynamic tests can be determined.
The peak of KI is the Mode-I fracture toughness KIC and the slope of the pre-peak linear portion
of the KI (i.e.•
IK ) is the loading rate for the dynamic test.
6.2.3 Determination of Dynamic Fracture Energy
5Figure 6.3 shows a typical loading history (P2) and the corresponding crack surface opening
displacement (CSOD) history during a NSCB test with dynamic force balance achieved
throughout the test (i.e. P1=P2). The loading history is recorded by the strain gauges on the bars
and the CSOD is monitored by the LGG system. It will be proved in the next section that the
sample is in a quasi-static state as long as the dynamic force balance is achieved. The peak point
of the loading (A) thus corresponds to the fracture initiation in the specimen, as in a quasi-static
experiment. The temporal derivative of the CSOD history is the crack surface opening velocity
(CSOV) history. CSOV increases with time and then approaches a terminal velocity of v=13.9
m/s at the turning point B.
The two vertical lines passing through points A and B divide the whole deformation period into
three stages I-III. It is believed that in stage I the crack opens up elastically, in stage II the crack
propagates dynamically, and in stage III the fracture separates the sample into two pieces and the
two fragments rotate away from each other. The separation velocity of the two fragments
(normal to the bar axis) is approximately the terminal velocity of CSOV (for small angle of
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 143
rotation in stage III), and doubles the fragment velocity. The crack propagation process lasts
about ΔtAB = 53 μs as seen from CSOD and CSOV. Given the crack distance Ls=R-a=16 mm for
this test, the average crack growth velocity vf can be estimated to be about 300 m/s.
Figure 6.3 Typical loading history and CSOD history of the NSCB specimen tested in SHPB on Laurentian granite.
A high speed camera (Photron Fastcam SA1) is used to monitor the fracture initiation and
propagation process of the test as well as the trajectories of the fragments. The high speed
camera is placed perpendicular to the SHPB and specimen. Images are recorded at an interframe
interval of 8 μs; the sequence shown in 5Figure 6.4 represents only the frames of representative
features. The first two images show the pre-fabricated notch and the crack opening can be barely
seen. The opening of the NSCB crack becomes visible at t > 40 μs. At 80 μs, the NSCB
specimen is split completely into two fragments. The fragments then rotate about the contact
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 144
point between the specimen and the incident bar (A point in 5Figure 6.2). The rotation angle of
the fragment is measured to be 9° at 160 μs, 21° at 480 μs, and 32° at 800 μs. This indicates that
the angular velocity of the fragments is almost constant during the period (about 314 rad/s), and
the motion of the fragments is rotational.
Figure 6.4 Selected high speed camera images showing the fracture and fragmentation of a NSCB Laurentian granite specimen.
The high speed camera imaging indicates that the fragments rotate around the axis along the
loading point at the incident bar side of the sample. The LGG system measures CSOD and the
fragment angular velocity can be deduced. The linear velocity of the two rotating fragments at
the LGG point is approximately the terminal velocity in the CSOV curve (5Figure 6.3). The
distance between the LGG and the rotating axis Δl = 18 mm, so the angular velocity ω= v/2/Δl =
313 rad/s for the snapshot shown in 6Figure 6.4, in excellent agreement with the result obtained
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 145
from high speed imaging. A similar method was used by Zhang et al., who used a high-speed
camera to estimate the fragment residual velocities (Zhang et al., 2000).
The energy conservation principle is then used to calculate the propagation fracture energy.
During the dynamic test, the energy dissipation (ΔW) pertaining to the fracture specimen is the
energy difference between the input energy (Wi) and the summation of the energy reflected (Wr)
and transmitted (Wt):
tri WWWW −−=Δ (6.5)
where W is the energy carried by the stress wave, which can be calculated as follows (Song and
Chen, 2006):
∫=t
ACdEW0
2 τε (6.6)
where E and C are the Young’s modulus and wave speed of the bar material respectively. A is
the cross-sectional area of the bar andε denotes the time-resolved strain induced by the stress
wave.
This energy dissipation ΔW has two parts: the energy consumed to create new crack surfaces WG
and the residue kinetic energy in the two cracked fragments K. For the rotating fragments (6Figure
6.4), the moment of inertia is I, and the total rotational kinetic energy is K = Iω2/2, where the
fragment angular velocity ω is estimated from the CSOD data with our optical device. The
energy consumed in generating new cracks thus can be reduced as WG = ΔW - K. Consequently,
the average propagation fracture energy is determined with Equation (6.6) below:
cGc AWG /= (6.7)
where Ac is the area of the new generated crack surfaces. For isotropic material, assuming plane
strain, the average dynamic propagation fracture toughness can be attained:
)1/( 2ν−= EGK cPI (6.8)
where E and ν are the Young’s modulus and Poisson’s ratio of the sample material respectively.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 146
6.3 Validation of Dynamic Notched Semi-Circular Bend Test
6.3.1 Dynamic Analysis and Fracture Time
6.3.1.1 Dynamic analysis
Dynamic finite element analysis is carried out to determine the SIF evolution by solving the
equation of motion with Newmark time integration method in ANSYS (Weisbrod and Rittel,
2000):
u&&ρ=⋅∇ σ (6.9)
where σ is the stress tensor, ρ denotes density, and u&& is the second time derivative of
displacement vector u . Assuming linear elastic material model, the elastodynamic response of
the NSCB specimen is solved. The finite element meshing is the same as 6Figure 6.2 while taking
the input loading F1 and F2 as half of the dynamic loading forces exerted on the incident side and
transmitted side of the sample, respectively (i.e., F1=P1/2, F2=P2/2 ). For a sample with a
stationary crack subjected to dynamic loading, the near-tip crack opening displacement (COD)
are similar to the static case as the following (Freund, 1990):
ππθ 2)()1(8)(
2
,r
EtKvtCOD I
r−
== (6.10)
For the half-crack model used in ANSYS, dynamic SIF is determined as:
rvEtVtK I
π2)1(4
)()( 2−= (6.11)
6.3.1.2 Fracture initiation detection
The fracture initiation time is detected by the strain gauge mounted on the sample surface near
the crack tip. The crack emits elastic release waves upon fracture initiation, and this wave causes
sudden drop in the recorded strain gauge signal (Jiang et al., 2004a). The lowest point of the drop
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 147
corresponds to the arrival of the release wave due to complete fracture initiation. It is noted that
this fracture initiation time should be corrected considering the time for the elastic wave to
propagate from the crack tip to the strain gauge. Thus, the adjusted strain gauge signal ε1(t)
follows as:
)()(1 ttt Δ+= εε (6.12)
where ε(t) is the original strain gauge signal. The travel time of the unloading wave from the
crack front to the strain gauge is determined as Δt=L/c, where L is the distance from the strain
gauge to the crack tip and c is the material elastic wave speed. The fracture initiation time is then
detected by the significant drop of the corrected strain signal ε1(t).
6.3.2 Dynamic NSCB Test without Pulse Shaping
In a conventional SHPB tests, impact of the striker on the incident bar generates a square shaped
incident stress wave. The rising portion of the incident wave is so sharp that high frequency
oscillations are inevitably introduced. 6Figure 6.5 shows the forces on both ends of the sample.
From Equation (6.1), the dynamic force on one side of the specimen P1 is the sum of the incident
(In.) and reflected (Re.) waves, and the dynamic force on the other side of the specimen P2 is the
transmitted wave (Tr.). It is evident from 6Figure 6.5 that a large fluctuation of dynamic force
occurs on the incident side and a sizeable distinction exists between forces on the two ends of the
specimen.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 148
0 50 100 150
-30
-20
-10
0
10
20
30
Forc
e (k
N)
Time (μs)
In. Tr. Re. In.+Re.
Figure 6.5 Dynamic forces on both ends of the NSCB specimen tested using a conventional SHPB on Laurentian granite. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
The measured CSOD of the NSCB specimen by LGG and the transmitted force in a conventional
SHPB test are illustrated in 6Figure 6.6. Two force peaks A and B are identified in the transmitted
force signal, occurring at time 62 μs and 94 μs respectively. More interestingly, over a rather
long time period, around 85 μs after the incident stress wave arrives at the sample, the measured
CSOD is negative. This means that the crack surfaces at the measuring site close rather than
open, a manifestation of the loading inertia effect. The closing of the crack surface may lead to
“loss of contact” between the transmitted side of the sample and the two pins (Bohme and
Kalthoff, 1982). This explains why after the first peak A of the transmitted force, an obvious
unloading is observed ( 6Figure 6.6). This unloading ends at trough C and then the load
continuously rises until the second peak B. From the CSOD signal, it can be seen that the trough
D almost synchronizes with C, indicating the completion of the unloading and the restart of the
loading phase.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 149
0 50 100 150-2
0
2
4
6
8
10
C
D
BA
20 μ s
Tr. Strain gauge CSOD
Time (μs)
Tran
smitt
ed fo
rce
(kN
)C
SO
D (0
.05
mm
)
-25
-20
-15
-10
-5
0
5
E
F
Strain gauge signal (m
V)
Figure 6.6 Comparison of CSOD and strain gage signal with the transmitted force of the NSCB specimen tested using a conventional SHPB on Laurentian granite (the unit for CSOD is 0.05 mm).
The signal from the strain gauge mounted on the sample surface is also depicted in 6Figure 6.6.
Two troughs E and F are visible from the strain gauge signal. The first trough E occurs at time 39
µs and the second trough F occurs at time 76 µs. The second trough F is lower and believed to
coincide with the fracture initiation time at 76 µs. Because the peak transmitted force occurs at
time 96 µs, the fracture initiation of the NSCB sample is thus 20 µs ahead of the peak
transmitted load. These observations show that due to the inertial effect, the far-field loads on the
sample boundary do not synchronize with the local load at the sample crack-tip. This kind of
loading inertial effect is similar to what was observed by Böhme and Kalthoff in a different
testing configuration (Bohme and Kalthoff, 1982).
6Figure 6.7 shows the evolution of SIF from both quasi-static and dynamic data reductions. The
static analysis is carried out using the transmitted force on both end of the sample ( 6Figure 6.2).
The overall trends of the two curves match with each other but the dynamic SIF features huge
fluctuation. Furthermore, the dynamic SIF is far from linear and therefore it is difficult to
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 150
achieve a constant loading rate. Consequently, the SIF from the quasi-static data reduction with
the far-field load recorded from the transmitted bar cannot reflect the transient SIF history in the
NSCB sample. The usage of the far-field loads such as the transmitted force to obtain the
fracture toughness with a quasi-static analysis will lead to tremendous error in the results. The
quasi-static equation is not valid for determining fracture toughness in a conventional SHPB test.
0 50 100 150
-3
-2
-1
0
1
2
3
4
5
SIF
(MP
a m
1/2 )
Time (μs)
Dynamic Quasi-static
Figure 6.7 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen tested using a conventional SHPB on Laurentian granite with both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis.
6.3.3 Dynamic NSCB Test with Careful Pulse Shaping
A composite pulse shaper, a combination of a C11000 copper (with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.7
mm in thickness) and a thin rubber shim (with 0.64 mm in diameter and 0.3 mm in thickness) is
utilized to shape the loading pulse. In a test with the same speed of striker as previous case, the
incident wave is shaped to a ramp pulse with a rising time of 150 µs, and a total pulse width of
300 µs ( 6Figure 6.8). Also shown in 6Figure 6.8 are the forces on both ends of the specimen. In
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 151
contrast to 6Figure 6.5, the forces on the two ends of the specimen exhibit no fluctuation and they
are almost identical before the maximum value is reached. The balance of dynamic forces on
both end of the sample is clearly achieved.
0 50 100 150 200 250 300-10
-5
0
5
10
15
Fo
rce
(kN
)
Time (μs)
In. Re. In.+Re. Tr.
Figure 6.8 Dynamic forces on both ends of the NSCB specimen tested using a modified SHPB on Laurentian granite. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
6Figure 6.9 illustrates the measured CSOD of the NSCB specimen by LGG and the transmitted
force in a modified SHPB test. The measured CSOD is always positive and there is a single peak
A in the transmitted force (6Figure 6.9), occurring at time 164 μs. The phenomenon of crack
closing due to inertia effects vanishes completely in this case.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 152
0 50 100 150 200 250 300-1
0
1
2
3
4A
B
Tr. Strain gauge CSOD
Time (μs)
-30
-20
-10
0
10
4 μ s
Strain gauge signal (m
V)Tr
ansm
itted
forc
e (k
N)
CS
OD
(0.0
5 m
m)
Figure 6.9 Comparison of CSOD and strain gage signal with the transmitted force of the NSCB specimen tested using a modified SHPB test on Laurentian granite (the unit for CSOD is 0.05 mm).
6Figure 6.9 also shows the signal from the strain gauge mounted on the sample surface near the
crack tip. Only one trough B is registered by the stain gauge, occurring at time 160 µs. Thus, the
fracture initiation time is designated by the unique trough B at time 160 µs. Because the peak
transmitted force occurs at time 164 µs, it is thus only 4 µs after the measured fracture onset. It
can be concluded that in this case, the peak far-field load matches with the fracture onset with
negligibly small time difference. The small time difference between them can be partially
interpreted as follows. The load on the specimen increases with the incident pulse before it
reaches the peak. At the fracture onset, release waves are emitted from the crack tip at the sound
speed of the rock material. The distance between the crack tip and the supporting pin is 12 mm
and it thus takes around 2.4 µs for the first release wave to reach the supporting pins. Due to the
interaction between the release wave and the pins, the load on the transmitted side decreases
( 6Figure 6.9). In addition, between 160 µs and 164 µs, the curve of transmitted force is almost flat
( 6Figure 6.9). The 4 µs time difference will thus lead to negligibly small error in the fracture
toughness.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 153
By carefully shaping the loading wave, the dynamic force balance on the boundary of the sample
is achieved ( 6Figure 6.8). However, with a 2D geometric configuration, the force balance on the
boundary does not necessarily guarantee the dynamic stress equilibrium in the entire specimen.
To address this issue, the SIF evolution is evaluated by dynamic finite element analysis, and the
result is compared with that from a quasi-static analysis (6Figure 6.10). The dynamic SIF exhibits
no fluctuation at all in contrast to that shown in 6Figure 6.7. The evolutions of SIF from both
static and dynamic methods match reasonably well.
100 150 200 250
0
1
2
3
4
SIF
(MP
a m
1/2 )
Time (μs)
Dynamic Quasi-static
Figure 6.10 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen tested using a modified SHPB on Laurentian granite with both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis.
From the above discussion, it is verified that with dynamic force balance in SHPB, the peak far-
field load coincides with the fracture onset. The fracture toughness can thus be confidently
deduced from the peak far-field load by virtue of quasi-static equations. For the case examined,
the dynamic fracture toughness is 3.47 MPa.m1/2, with the loading rate of 79.7 GPa.m1/2/s. It is
also noted that when there is no pulse shaper, the failure time is at 76 µs. The corresponding
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 154
dynamic stress intensity factor is 1.5 MPa.m1/2 ( 6Figure 6.6). This value can not be used as the
dynamic fracture toughness because it carries significant errors. First, the loading condition is
not well defined due to the oscillation of the load. Secondly, the oscillation is due to the
dispersion of stress waves in the bar system, and thus it only represents the trend of the dynamic
load but not the accurate force at individual measurement points. As a matter of fact, the static
fracture toughness of this rock is about 1.5 MPa.m1/2 (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008). The dynamic
fracture toughness should be much higher. Hence, again, the test without pulse shaper is not
reliable.
Following proposed methods, the fracture initiation toughness and fracture energy of Laurentian
granite are measured. As illustrated in 6Figure 6.11, the dynamic fracture initiation toughness and
fracture energy increase almost linearly with increasing loading rates.
20 40 60 80 1000
1
2
3
4
5
6
Gc (kJ/m
2)
KIC
Gc
KIC
(MP
a m1/
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
Figure 6.11 The effect of loading rate on the fracture toughness and fracture energy of Laurentian granite.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 155
6.4 Fracture Toughness Anisotropy of Barre Granite
6.4.1 Determination of Anisotropic Stress Intensity Factor
Suppose ija are the elastic compliance which defines the relationship between the stress ijσ and
strain ijε . For orthotropic material in plane stress, one has
⎥⎥⎥
⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎢
⎣
⎡
⎥⎥⎥
⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎢
⎣
⎡=
⎥⎥⎥
⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎢
⎣
⎡
12
22
11
662616
262212
161211
12
22
11
σσσ
γεε
aaaaaaaaa
(6.13)
111
1E
a = (6.14a)
222
1E
a = (6.14b)
2
21
1
1212 E
vEv
a−
=−
= (6.14c)
1266
1G
a = (6.14d)
where iE is the Young’s modulus in the i principle direction, 12G is the shear modulus in the
21− plane, ijv is the Poisson’s ratio define the extensional strain in the j direction produced by
a unit compressive strain in the i direction.
For plane strain, ija is replaced by ijb according to the following equations:
33
33
aaa
ab jiijij −= ; 2,1, =ji (6.15)
where
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 156
3
323 E
vEva i
i
ii
−=
−= (6.16)
and
333
1E
a = (6.17)
6Figure 6.12 defines a local coordinate system in relation with the orthotropic material directions.
The stress and displacement of fields in the vicinity of the crack tip can be expressed analytically
below in turn (Tan and Gao, 1992).
y
x
r
θ
ϕE1E2
crack
Figure 6.12 Local coordinate system for the stress and displacement fields near the crack tip of an orthotropic solid.
Stress fields are:
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 157
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−+
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−=
2/11
21
2/12
22
21
2/11
12/1
2
2
21
21
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re
2
)sin(cos)sin(cosRe
2
θθθθπ
θθθθπσ
ss
ss
ssrK
ss
ss
ssss
rK
II
Ixx
(6.18a)
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−+
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−=
2/12
2/1221
2/11
12/1
2
2
21
)sin(cos1
)sin(cos11Re
2
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re
2
θθθθπ
θθθθπσ
ssssrK
ss
ss
ssrK
II
Iyy
(6.18b)
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−+
⎥⎥⎦
⎤
⎢⎢⎣
⎡
⎭⎬⎫
⎩⎨⎧
+−
+−=
2/12
22/1
2
1
21
2/11
2/1221
21
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re
2
)sin(cos1
)sin(cos1Re
2
θθθθπ
θθθθπσ
ss
ss
ssrK
ssssss
rK
II
Ixy
(6.18c)
Displacements are:
{ }
{ }⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡+−+
−+
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡+−+
−=
2/111
2/122
21
2/1112
2/1221
21
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re2
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re2
θθθθπ
θθθθπ
spspss
rK
spsspsss
rKu
II
Ix
(6.19a)
{ }
{ }⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡+−+
−+
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡+−+
−=
2/111
2/122
21
2/1112
2/1221
21
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re2
)sin(cos)sin(cos1Re2
θθθθπ
θθθθπ
sqsqss
rK
sqssqsss
rKu
II
Iy
(6.19b)
where,
iii saasap 16122
11 ′−′+′= (6.20a)
i
iii s
saasaq 26222
12 ′−′+′= ; 2,1=i (6.20b)
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 158
ija′ are the compliance constants in the local x-y coordinate system. For orthotropic material, it is
related to ija according to the following equations,
ϕϕϕϕ 422
226612
41111 sincossin)2(cos aaaaa +++=′ (6.21a)
ϕϕϕϕ 422
226612
41122 coscossin)2(sin aaaaa +++=′ (6.21b)
ϕϕ 22661222111212 cossin)2( aaaaaa −−++=′ (6.21c)
ϕϕ 22661222116666 cossin)2(4 aaaaaa −−++=′ (6.21d)
ϕϕϕϕ 2sin]2/2cos)2(cossin[ 66122
112
2216 aaaaa ++−−=′ (6.21e)
ϕϕϕϕ 2sin]2/2cos)2(cossin[ 66122
112
2226 aaaaa ++−−=′ (6.21f)
1s and 2s are related to 1T and 2T , which are the roots of the following characteristic equation for
an orthotropic material, according to Lekhnitskii (1963).
0)2( 222
66124
11 =+++ aaaa μμ (6.22)
The roots of this equation are either complex or purely imaginary and cannot be real. They are:
1111 ηζμ iT +== (6.23a)
2222 ηζμ iT +== (6.23b)
13 μμ = (6.23c)
24 μμ = (6.23d)
where, 1−=i , the overbar denotes the complex conjugate here. iζ and iη are real constants. It
is always true that 0,0 21 >> ηη , 21 ηη ≠ .
The relationship between ks and kT is shown (Lekhnitskii, 1963) to be:
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 159
;sincossincos
ϕϕϕϕ
k
kk T
Ts
−+
= .2,1=k (6.24)
The stresses yyσ and xxσ ahead of the crack tip and in the plane of the crack could be obtained
by substituting 0=θ into Equation (6.18),
rKI
yy πσ
2= ;
rKII
xy πσ
2= (6.25)
By substituting o180=θ into Equation (6.19), the near-tip displacement u and v on the crack
face may be given in matrix form as:
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡=⎥
⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡
II
I
y
x
KK
DDDDr
uu
2221
12112π
(6.26)
where
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡−−
=21
211211 Im
sspspsD (6.27a)
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡−−
=21
2112 Im
ssppD (6.27b)
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡−−
=21
211221 Im
ssqsqsD (6.27c)
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡−−
=21
2122 Im
ssqqD (6.27d)
⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡⎥⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡=⎥
⎦
⎤⎢⎣
⎡∗∗
∗∗
y
x
II
I
uu
DDDD
rKK
2221
1211
2π (6.28)
and
DDD /2211 =∗ DDD /2121 −=∗ (6.29a)
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 160
DDD /1212 −=∗ DDD /1122 −=∗ (6.29b)
211222112221
1211 DDDDDDDD
D −== (6.30)
If the crack lies parallel to the global x-axis, and also parallel to one of the material symmetry
plane, in the pure Mode-I case,
21
12 Dr
uK y
I ⋅=π (6.31)
Let BrAr
u y += , two nearest nodes at the crack tip are used to determine the factor A. IK could
then be calculated using the following equation:
212 DAK I ⋅=
π (6.32)
6.4.2 Determination of Fracture Toughness of Barre Granite
6.4.2.1 Calculating equation
Static measurement is conducted with an MTS hydraulic servo-control testing system ( 6Figure
6.13a). Dynamic test is conducted using a 25 mm SHPB system (6Figure 6.13b) and the specimen
is sandwiched between the incident and transmitted bars. The specimens used in this study have
a nominal thickness B= 16 mm, radius R= 20 mm and a crack length a= 5 mm. The calculating
equation of the fracture toughness of anisotropic Barre granite follows the same equation as
before [Equation (6.1)], except that the stress intensity factor for anisotropic fracture problems
has to be taken into account via Equation (6.32).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 161
Figure 6.13 Schematics of the straight through notched semi-circular bend fracture test in (a) the material testing machine and (b) the SHPB system.
6.4.2.2 Testing example
First, a crack problem is presented below to demonstrate the validation of the approach for the
determination of stress intensity factor in a plane of orthotropic elasticity. An infinite strip with a
finite width W, an edge crack with length of a, subjected to a remote uniform traction σ
perpendicular to the plane of the crack is illustrated in 6Figure 6.14.
E1
E2 σσa
W
Figure 6.14 An infinite orthotropic strip with an edge crack under remote uniform tractions normal to the edge crack.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 162
Using an integral equation approach, Kaya and Erdogan solved this problem for a special case of
orthotropy (Kaya and Erdogan, 1980). Tan and Gao also researched on this problem to calibrate
their integral equation with boundary element method (Tan and Gao, 1992). The material chosen
in their investigation was a boron-epoxy composite with material properties as
follows: 1E =170.65 GPa, 2E =55.16 GPa, 12G =4.83 GPa and 12v =0.1114.
Six cases are calculated with dimensionless crack length vary from 0.1 to 0.6. By virtue of the
symmetry, half of the strip is modeled. The length of the strip is modeled ten times of the width
W. 6Figure 6.15 illustrates a mesh of 530 PLANE82 elements and 1683 nodes for a typical edge
crack problem with a dimensionless crack length a/W=0.6.
Close view of crack tip elements
1434
Figure 6.15 The overall mesh of the strip and a close-view of the mesh in the vicinity of the crack tip; the length of the trip is modeled as ten times of the width W.
The normalized stress intensity factor aKK II πσ/* = for all six cases are calculated and
tabulated in 6Table 6.1, along with the results reported by Kaya and Erdogan (1980) and Tan and
Gao (1992) for comparison. The results are highly satisfactory, with the maximum error less than
1 % for most of the cases.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 163
Table 6.1 The normalized stress intensity factor aKK II πσ/* = , for an edge crack in an
infinite orthotropic strip with remote uniform traction σ.
a/W
KEIK )( *
TIK )( *
ANIK )( *
KEANIKΔ
(%)
TANIKΔ
(%) 0.1 1.128 1.114 1.134 0.5 1.8 0.2 1.320 1.334 1.320 0.0 -1.0 0.3 1.607 1.624 1.612 0.3 -0.7 0.4 2.042 2.057 2.050 0.4 -0.3 0.5 2.720 2.715 2.734 0.5 0.7 0.6 3.860 3.832 3.878 0.5 1.2
KEIK )( * : Results by Kaya and Erdogan (1980)
TIK )( * : Traction formula result by Tan and Gao (1992)
ANIK )( * : Results by ANSYS in this study
KEANIKΔ = 100
)()()(
*
**
×−
KEI
KEIANI
KKK
TANIKΔ = 100
)()()(
*
**
×−
TI
TIANI
KKK
6.4.2.3 Anisotropic fracture toughness of Barre granite
With confidence on the numerical method to determine the anisotropic stress intensity factor, the
critical stress intensity factor can then be calculated with the critical load recorded from
experiments. For the six samples suites, XZ, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY, the factor 21D are
determined and tabulated in 6Table 6.2.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 164
Table 6.2 The material properties used in the finite element model of NSCB samples of
Barre granite along six directions.
Sample Suites
12D (Pa-1)
1E (GPa)
2E (GPa)
12G (GPa)
12v
XY 5.95E-11 40.7 32.2 15.8 0.093 XZ 5.58E-11 54.8 32.2 17.7 0.105 YX 5.30E-11 32.2 40.7 15.8 0.073 YZ 4.59E-11 54.8 40.7 20.6 0.146 ZX 4.28E-11 32.2 54.8 17.7 0.062 ZY 3.95E-11 40.7 54.8 20.6 0.108
Taking advantage of the symmetry of the NSCB specimen, half model is constructed for the
finite element analysis. PLANE82 element (2D eight-node structural solid) is also used in the
analysis. Quarter-nodal element (singular element) (Barsoum, 1977) is applied to the vicinity of
the crack tip in meshing the finite element model, to better simulate the stress singularity near the
crack tip (r is the radius to the crack tip). The total model is meshed with 2357 elements and
7252 nodes as shown in 6Figure 6.16. The orthotropic material constants in the finite element
model for six sample suites are also listed in 6Table 6.2, with reference to 6Figure 3.2 in Chapter 3.
Figure 6.16 Mesh for the NSCB specimen and crack tip local coordinate system (a) mesh of the half model (b) close view of the crack tip mesh (c) crack tip coordinate system.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 165
6.4.3 Fracture Toughness Anisotropy
6.4.3.1 Dynamic equilibrium
As demonstrated in the previous subsection, as long as the dynamic forces on both ends of the
NSCB sample have been achieved during the test, the inertial effect in the sample can be
effectively minimized, and the quasi-static data reduction scheme can be utilized to determine
the fracture toughness of rocks. We thus only need guarantee the balance of the time-resolved
dynamic force on both ends of the NSCB sample. To do so, pulse shaping technique is employed
for all the dynamic tests and the dynamic force balance on the two loading ends of the sample
has been compared before data processing. 6Figure 6.17 compares the time-varying forces on both
ends of the sample in the typical test on sample YZ with pulse shaping.
Figure 6.17 Dynamic force balance check for a typical NSCB fracture test of Barre granite with pulse shaping. In.: incident; Re.: reflected; Tr.: transmitted.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 166
It is evident that with pulse shaping, the dynamic forces on both sides of the samples match with
each other up to the maximum loading (i.e. critical failure point), from which the dynamic
fracture toughness can be calculated via Equation (6.1).
The dynamic NSCB method is then applied to all six sample groups of Barre granite. 6Figure
6.18a and b show the examples of the virgin NSCB samples and recovered ones after tests,
respectively. Along the loading directions, the NSCB samples are split into two quarter disc
approximately (see 6Figure 6.18b). It is noted that for all dynamic fracture tests conducted on the
SHPB system, the force balance on both ends of the sample has been checked; and all samples
are subject to single-pulse loading with the momentum trap technique, which prevents further
damage to the sample due to the multiple loading pulses.
(a) (b)
Figure 6.18 (a) Virgin NSCB samples and (b) recovered NSCB samples of Barre granite.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 167
6.4.3.2 Static fracture toughness anisotropy
Three independent static tests have been conducted on each of the six groups of Barre granite
samples (i.e. XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY) and the fracture toughness for each group is taken
as the average value. 6Figure 6.19 shows the variation of fracture toughness measured along six
different directions for Barre granite. The highest fracture toughness of Barre granite is
1.74±0.06 MPa·m1/2, from sample ZX split within Z plane. The other sample group split within Z
plane (i.e. ZY) owns the second highest fracture toughness of 1.57±0.04 MPa·m1/2. The average
fracture toughness measured from samples split in Y planes (i.e. YZ and YX) yields intermediate
fracture toughness of 1.42±0.04 and 1.20±0.06 MPa·m1/2, respectively. The lowest and the
second lowest fracture toughness are measured along two fracture directions split within X plane
(i.e. XY and XZ), exhibiting average KIC values of 1.02±0.04 MPa·m1/2 and 1.11±0.06 MPa·m1/2,
respectively. The measured static fracture toughness exhibits very strong anisotropy, with the
highest measured fracture toughness (1.74 MPa·m1/2, for sample ZX) 1.7 times of the lowest
(1.02 MPa·m1/2, for sample XY).
XY XZ YX YZ ZX ZY0.0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.81.57
1.74
1.421.20
1.111.02
KIC
(MPa
m1/
2 )
Figure 6.19 The variation of static fracture toughness of Barre granite on six sample groups, i.e. XY, XZ, YX, YZ, ZX and ZY.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 168
6.4.3.3 Dynamic fracture toughness anisotropy
All the dynamic fracture toughness and fracture energy values with corresponding loading rates
are tabulated in 6Table 6.3. 6Figure 6.20 illustrates the variation of fracture toughness values with
loading rates along six directions. Within the range of loading rates available, the fracture
toughness increases with the loading rate for each direction in approximately the same rate. This
reveals that: 1) the rate of the increment of the dynamic fracture toughness with loading rate
appear to be the same for all directions and 2) the order of the highest fracture toughness to the
lowest among six directions remains approximately the same as that in the static case.
0 40 80 120 160 2000
2
4
6
8
10
ZX ZY YZ YX XZ XY
KIC
(MP
a m1/
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
Figure 6.20 The variation of fracture toughness with loading rates on six directions of Barre granite.
As before, it is also apparent from Figure 3.2 in Chapter 3 that the fracture plane of the disc
(noted as the first index in the sample terminology) has a sizeable influence on the fracture
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 169
toughness; while the fracture propagation direction (the second index in the sample terminology)
also has some influence on the measured fracture toughness. The samples in Z plane own the
highest fracture toughness; while samples in X plane, the least.
The variation of dynamic fracture energy with loading rates along six directions is shown in
6Figure 6.21. Generally, within the range of loading rates available, the fracture energy increases
with the loading rate for each direction, but in different rate. The data are much more scattered
than the fracture toughness measurements; and samples split in Z plane appear to have higher
fracture energy than the other two planes, showing the influence of the pre-existing microcracks
to the measured fracture energy to some extent.
40 80 120 160 2000
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 ZX ZY YZ YX XZ XY
GC (k
J/m
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
Figure 6.21 The variation of fracture energy with loading rates on six directions of Barre granite.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 170
Similar to previous two anisotropic indexes introduced in Chapter 4 and Chapter 5, the
anisotropic index of fracture toughness, αk is defined as the ratio of the maximum fracture
toughness to the minimum fracture toughness within six sample groups. 6Figure 6.22a and b show
the two extremes of the variation of fracture toughness. The sample group ZX with splitting
plane normal to Z axis owns the highest fracture toughness while sample XY with splitting plane
normal to X axis yields the lowest.
The variation of the anisotropic index of fracture toughness αk with loading rates is shown in
6Figure 6.22c. Under static loading, αk equals to 1.70; under dynamic loading, it decreases rapidly.
For example, under the loading rate around 20 MPa·m1/2s-1, sample ZX axis owes the highest
fracture toughness of 3.27 MPa·m1/2 and XY axis shows the lowest value of 2.34 MPa·m1/2, and
αk is 1.40. As the loading rate is 220 MPa·m1/2s-1, αk is about 1.20 and the maximum fracture
toughness remains still in samples ZX with a value of 11.0 MPa·m1/2 and the lowest one is fixed
in samples XY as 9.1 MPa·m1/2. Thus, Barre granite obviously exhibits stronger anisotropy under
static loading, while relatively lower anisotropy during dynamic loading. In addition, as shown in
6Figure 6.22c, αk drops quickly towards the isotropic value of 1. This suggests that under very
high loading rates (e. g. shock wave loading) the fracture toughness anisotropy is negligible and
the fracture toughness under such circumstances appear to be isotropic.
In the next section, a crack-microcrak interaction model is constructed to interpret the apparent
loading rate dependence of the fracture toughness anisotropy of Barre granite. Both static and
dynamic analyses have been conducted. The pronounced feature of the same rate of increase of
the loading rate dependence of the Mode-I fracture toughness is also mimicked.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 171
(a)
(c)
(b)
0 50 100 150 200 250
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
1.7
α
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
0 50 100 150 2000
2
4
6
8
XY (X Plane)KIC
(MPa
m1/
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)0 50 100 150 200
2
4
6
8
10
ZX (Z Plane)KIC
(MPa
m1/
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
k
Figure 6.22 The fracture toughness with loading rates for sample group of (a) XY, splitting in the plane normal to X axis; (b) ZX, splitting in the plane normal to Z axis; and (c) the fracture toughness anisotropic index αk of Barre granite.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 172
Table 6.3 Fracture toughness and fracture energy of Barre granite with corresponding
loading rates from both static and dynamic NSCB fracture tests.
XY
XZ
No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 1 8E-5 1.06 N/A 1 1E-4 1.10 N/A 2 8E-5 1.02 N/A 2 1E-4 1.18 N/A 3 8E-5 0.98 N/A 3 1E-4 1.05 N/A 4 43.8 2.88 0.51 4 28.2 2.51 0.43 5 62.0 4.02 0.68 5 37.3 3.25 0.55 6 73.4 3.89 1.01 6 73.6 4.41 0.78 7 100.0 4.94 1.25 7 87.0 5.31 2.02 8 106.6 5.69 1.90 8 124.9 6.42 2.15 9 123.3 6.23 1.91 9 135 6.60 2.59
10 134.5 6.05 2.45 10 158.5 7.22 2.28 11 175.7 7.31 3.20 11 159.0 7.58 3.53 12 180.0 7.80 3.61 12 198.4 8.72 3.83
YX YZ
No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 1 1E-4 1.19 N/A 1 9E-5 1.40 N/A 2 1E-4 1.26 N/A 2 9E-5 1.39 N/A 3 1E-4 1.15 N/A 3 9E-5 1.47 N/A 4 28.4 2.22 0.46 4 40.4 3.54 0.54 5 81.1 4.35 1.28 5 47.5 3.43 0.72 6 86.9 4.57 1.45 6 48.2 4.01 0.93 7 101.0 5.50 1.95 7 79.4 4.45 1.33 8 114.2 6.31 2.08 8 82.2 4.94 1.57 9 165.0 7.96 3.38 9 94.4 5.53 2.28
10 179.0 8.56 4.05 10 135.8 6.77 2.35 11 187.4 8.38 4.55 11 140.0 7.59 3.87 12 191.2 8.93 4.80 12 171.8 8.30 4.14
ZX ZY
No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 No. ICK&
GPa m1/2s-1 ICK
MPa m1/2 cG
kJ/m2 1 9E-5 1.79 N/A 1 1E-4 1.55 N/A 2 9E-5 1.67 N/A 2 1E-4 1.54 N/A 3 9E-5 1.76 N/A 3 1E-4 1.62 N/A 4 29.0 3.46 0.78 4 24.5 2.96 0.58 5 45.4 4.27 1.17 5 60.5 4.62 1.16 6 68.8 5.27 1.51 6 81.1 5.30 1.73 7 76.5 5.36 2.55 7 100.0 5.60 2.05 8 85.4 5.67 2.57 8 103.5 6.16 3.00 9 113.1 7.20 4.10 9 140.0 7.70 3.40
10 156.1 8.75 4.61 10 166.8 8.77 4.23 11 179.9 9.60 6.27 11 190.2 9.24 4.19 12 201.1 9.90 7.26 12 199.0 9.36 5.62
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 173
6.5 Crack-Microcrack Interaction
6.5.1 Background
The phenomenon of a microcracking zone near the main crack tip and its effects on the
propagation of main crack in brittle materials such as ceramics, rocks and concretes (Claussen et
al., 1977; Evans and Faber, 1981; Hoagland et al., 1973) has been discussed by many
researchers. Existing theoretical analysis has focused on the effect of microcracking on the stress
field near the main crack tip. Due to the complexity of the problem, except for a few simple
cases, closed-form solutions are not available. As a result, most previous studies are confined to
semi-analytical solutions. Generally speaking, researchers attempted to model this problem in
two perspectives. One is the continuum mechanics model, which aims at building a constitutive
framework in the continuously damaged material mimicking the overall effect of microcracking
(Hutchinson, 1987; Ortiz, 1987). However, due to the complexity of the interacting problem, no
agreement has been reached among researchers on what is the best material model to simulate
the configuration of crack-microcrack interaction. The second approach considers the multiple
microcracks in the microcrack zone near the tip of a main crack as discrete entities; in which
case, interaction is assessed using the stress function or assumed stress state with superposition
principle. Examples of this type of modeling include the work of Chudnovsky and Kachanov
(1983), Rose (1986) and Chudnovsky et al.(1987). However, most of these models adopted some
inconsistent and/or unrealistic assumptions and consequently their accuracy is rather limited
(Gong and Horii, 1989).
The method of pseudo-tractions, proposed by Horii and Nemat-Nasser (1985), further improved
by Gong and Horii (1989), has been proved to be an effective approach to analyze the crack
microcrack interaction problem. Based on the complex potentials of Muskhelishvili (1953) and
the principle of superposition, this method can treat general problems with any number of
interacting cracks or other inhomogeneities (Gong and Horii, 1989). Herein, the concept of
crack-microcrack interaction is demonstrated using the 0-order and 1st-order solution of the
pseudo-traction method by Gong and Horri (1989). The stress shielding and amplification region
due to the location and orientation of microcracks with respect to the main crack are also
discussed.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 174
Although there are many interesting discussions on the effects of shielding and amplification of
the main crack due to the presence of microcracks, few of them have a strong experimental basis.
Mode I fracture toughness KIC measurements on four types of granites (Nasseri and Mohanty,
2008; Nasseri et al., 2006) were carried out under the standard procedure by the ISRM
recommended method in 1995 (Fowell et al., 1995), showed varying degree of anisotropy. In that
measurement of fracture toughness anisotropy of Barre granite, an isotropic material model was
assumed to determine the fracture toughness values (Nasseri and Mohanty, 2008; Nasseri et al.,
2006).
In this research with semi-circular bend fracture tests, orthotropic material model with material
constants measured from literature (Sano et al., 1992) is used to estimate the true stress intensity
near the crack tip. As discussed before, fracture toughness anisotropy has also been observed
from testing results, featuring different degree of anisotropy regarding to the loading rates. For
the first time, the loading rate dependence of fracture toughness anisotropy of Barre granite is
reported in the rock community. The variation of fracture toughness with respect to the loading
rates will be interpreted on the basis of crack-microcrack interaction in the microscopic scale.
Microstructural observation with a newly developed technique of computer-aided image analysis
program clearly showed the microcrack density and orientation around the propagation path of
the main crack. From two images of thin sections that correspond to the two confronting cases of
fracture toughness measurements, two physical crack microcrack models are constructed. The
existing theoretical formulas are not applicable to the proposed models due to the assumptions
made in the theoretical derivation. Thus, finite element analysis with the commercial software
package ANSYS is used to determine the effects of embedded microcracks on the disturbance of
the stress field at the vicinity of the main crack. The finite element method has been proved to be
an effective method to handle this type of problem (Meguid et al., 1991), especially when the
microcrack is very close to the main crack. The numerical results can simulate the experimental
measurements very well, which implies that the preferred distribution and orientation of pre-
existing mircocracks in the nominally homogeneous rocks is responsible for the anisotropy of
fracture toughness.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 175
6.5.2 Microstructural Investigation and Featuring Models
In order to understand the physical mechanism of fracture toughness anisotropy, two thin
sections of rock samples corresponding to the two confronting measurements of fracture
toughness of Barre granite are captured and illustrated in 6Figure 6.23a for Case 1 and 6Figure
6.24a for Case 2, (Courtesy of Dr. M. H.B. Nasseri). 6Figure 6.23a corresponds to the crack-
microcracks orientation in Barre granite for the situation in which the fracture toughness is the
highest. In Case 1, the main crack propagates from the tip of the notch with an acute angle to
most microcracks. 6Figure 6.24a shows the microcracks density and orientation in Barre granite
for the case in which the fracture toughness is the lowest. In Case 2, the main crack is collinear
to most microcracks.
6Figure 6.23b (Model 1) and 6Figure 6.24b (Model 2) depict two conceptual models based on
6Figure 6.23a and 6Figure 6.24a respectively, taking only into account the nearest few microcracks
near the tip of the main crack. Only the nearest microcracks are considered because it has been
shown from both continuum and discrete models that the interaction is dominated by the nearest
microcracks (Hutchinson, 1990). Based on the statistics of the configuration of microcracks in
6Figure 6.23a, Model 1 is constructed ( 6Figure 6.23b), where two symmetric microcracks near the
notch tip are oriented at an angle of o45 to the horizontal main crack surface. Denote the length
of the microcrack by 2c, the distance from the right tip of the microcrack to the tip of the main
crack is 0.2c. The conceptual model shown in 6Figure 6.24b is based on the thin section photo of
6Figure 6.24a. In this case, existing microcracks are mostly parallel to the propagation path of the
main fracture. For comparison purposes, the same length of the microcrack of 2c and the same
distance from the main crack tip to the closest microcrack tip of 0.2c are used. Particular
attention is directed to the crack-microcracks interaction of the two conceptual models for an
insight on the observed anisotropy of KIC.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 176
Figure 6.23 (a) Photo of microscopic thin section showing microcracks in a tested Barre granite sample; Case 1: the main crack inclines at an angle of o45 to microcracks; (b) Model 1: the crack-microcracks configuration for Case 1.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 177
Figure 6.24 (a) Photo of microscopic thin section showing microcracks in a tested Barre granite sample; Case 2: The main crack is collinear to microcracks; (b) Model 2: the crack-microcracks configuration for Case 2.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 178
6.5.3 The Crack-Microcrack Interaction
Consider a general problem of a semi-infinite main crack and an arbitrarily located and oriented
microcrack, as shown in 6Figure 6.25. Denote the distance between the main crack tip and the
center of the microcrack by d and the length of the microcrack by 2c. The angle measured from
the x -axis to the line connecting the tip of the main crack and the center of the microcrack is θ
and the microcrack orientation is defined by the angle φ from x -axis to the 'x -axis.
Figure 6.25 One arbitrarily located microcrack near the crack tip of a semi-infinite crack.
In the following, 0IK denotes the stress intensity factor of the main crack without microcracks;
MAIK denotes the local stress intensity factor of the main crack. As a demonstration, the method
proposed by Gong and Horii (1989) are used to calculate the ratio between MAIK and 0
IK with
both 0th order approximation and 1st order approximation for the case where 2/ =cd .
The original problem was decomposed into three sub-problems: I, II and III (6Figure 6.26).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 179
=
+
+
Original Problem Sub-Problem I
Sub-Problem II Sub-Problem III
K0I ,K
0II
σ0(x),τ0(x)
−σ0(x0),−τ0(x0)
δKI,δKII
σp(x),τp(x)
σ(x0),τ(x0)
−[τ0(x)+τp(x)]
−[σ0(x)+σp(x)]
Figure 6.26 The original problem and the three sub-problems decomposed from the original one based on the superposition method.
Sub-problem I contains the main crack subjected to applied Mode-I stress intensity factor 0IK and
Mode-II stress intensity factor 0IIK . The undisturbed stresses )(0 xσ and )(0 xτ along the location
of the microcrack can be determined by virtue of the stress function of Muskhelishvili (1953).
In sub-problem II, in order to satisfy the boundary conditions of the original problem, a pair of
pseudo-tractions σp(x) and τp(x) is applied to the microcrack; and the microcrack is stressed under
the traction pair of –[σ0(x)+σp(x)] and –[τ0(x)+τp(x)]. In this case, the induced stresses along the
main crack can be expressed and denoted as σ(x0) and τ(x0).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 180
In the sub-problem III, the main crack is subjected to tractions equivalent to the negative values
of the induced stresses at the same location in sub-problem II. Assessing the whole processes, it
is obvious that traction-free condition along the main crack surfaces is satisfied automatically.
The traction-free condition along the microcrack requires the induced stresses at the position of
microcrack equal to the pseudo-tractions σp(x) and τp(x) and this will lead to a couple of
consistency equations to finally complete the series of equations (Gong and Horii, 1989).
For fracture tests, the resulting fracture mode is pure Mode-I, thus in the current analysis, the far-
field loading of 0IIK is zero. Consequently, the 0th-order approximate solution, which gives the
first two terms of the stress intensity factors of the main crack, is as follows (Gong and Horii,
1989):
0)21(0)12(2)11(0)11(2
20 ][)(41
IIMAI KABAB
dcKK ⋅⋅+⋅⋅+= (6.33)
The 1st-order approximate solution, which gives the first three terms of the stress intensity factors
for the main crack, is as follows (Gong and Horii, 1989):
{
} 0)22(02)12(2)12(02)11(2)21(0)21(02)12(2)11(02)11(2)11(0
)21(1)12(3)11(1)11(3)21(2)12(2)11(2)11(2)21(0)12(4
)11(0)11(440
)21(0)12(2)11(0)11(220
)(8)(8
)(4)(3)
(24)(128
1][)(41
I
IIMAI
KDBDBADBDBA
ABABABABAB
ABdcKABAB
dcKK
⋅⋅+⋅+⋅+⋅+
⋅+⋅+⋅+⋅+⋅+
⋅+⋅⋅+⋅⋅+=
(6.34)
where
])25()2cos[()
21(
21
])21()2cos[(
41])
21(cos[)2(
21
)11(
θφ
θφθφ
+−++−
+−+++−+=
nnn
nnnnnAn
(6.35a)
])25()2sin[()
21(
21
])21()2sin[(
43])
21(sin[)2(
21
)12(
θφ
θφθφ
+−++−
+−+−+−+=
nnn
nnnnnAn
(6.35b)
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 181
])25()2sin[()
21(
21
])21()2sin[(
41])
21(sin[
2)21(
θφ
θφθφ
+−++−
+−+++−=
nnn
nnnnnAn
(6.35c)
])25()2cos[()
21(
21
])21()2cos[(
43])
21(cos[
2)22(
θφ
θφθφ
+−+++
+−+++−−=
nnn
nnnnnAn
(6.35d)
])21sin[()sin(2])2()
21cos[(
])21cos[()2( 11)11(
φθθφθ
φθ
kkkpkk
kpkkpkB
k
kkk
−++−−−×
+−−−−= −−
(6.35e)
])21cos[()sin(2])2()
21sin[(
)2(])21sin[()2( 11)12(
φθθφθ
φθ
kkkpkk
pkkkpkB
k
kkk
−++−−−×
−+−−−−= −−
(6.35f)
])21cos[()sin(2])2()
21sin[(
])21sin[( 11)21(
φθθφθ
φθ
kkkpkk
kpkkkpB
k
kkk
−++−−−×
−−−= −−
(6.35g)
])21sin[()sin(2])2()
21cos[(
)2(])21cos[( 11)22(
φθθφθ
φθ
kkkpkk
pkkkkpB
k
kkk
−+−−−−×
−+−−= −−
(6.35h)
)]45cos()44cos(2)43cos()23cos(2
)2cos(6)2cos()cos(2)2cos(415[)cos1(16
1)11(02
φθφθφθφθ
φθθθφθ
−−−−−−−+
−−−−++
=D (6.35i)
)]45sin()44sin(2)43sin(
)23sin()2sin(3)2sin(2[)cos1(16
1)21(02)12(02
φθφθφθ
φθφθφθ
−+−+−+
−−−++
== DD (6.35j)
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 182
)]45cos()44cos(2
)43cos()2cos()cos(27[)cos1(16
1)22(02
φθφθ
φθθθθ
−+−+
−+−−+
=D (6.35k)
In the above expressions, 22 )!(2)!2(
kkp kk = . The factorial !k is defined as a positive integer k as:
12)1(! ⋅⋅⋅⋅−= kkk .
6Figure 6.27 shows the different regions in which the stress intensity factor at the tip of the main
crack may be either increased (amplification, 1/ 0 >IMAI KK ) or decreased (shielding,
1/ 0 <IMAI KK ), depending on the location and orientation of the microcracks relative to the main
crack. This effect of amplification or shielding of the stress intensity factor of the main crack due
to the presence of the microcracks can be of vital significance to the anisotropy of rocks and
hence can result in sizeable variations of the measured fracture toughness in the experiments.
It has been recognized from both continuum and discrete perspectives that the nearest
microcracks have the dominant effects on the stress redistribution at the tip of the main crack
(Hutchinson, 1990). The influence of microcracks far from the immediate tip region of the main
crack appears to be less important. Therefore, it is accurate enough to consider only one or two
microcracks closest to the tip of the main crack, just as the crack/microcracks configurations in
6Figure 6.23b (Case 1) and 6Figure 6.24b (Case 2). In the following, the two proposed conceptual
models in 6Figure 6.23b and 6Figure 6.24b are analyzed with finite element method to quantify the
shielding or amplification effects of main crack due to the presence of the nearest microcracks.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 183
0 20 40 60 80 100 120 140 160 180
20
40
60
80
100
120
140
160
180
KMAI
/K0I<1
(shielding) KMA
I/K0
I>1
(amplification)
0 order 1st order
θ (d
egre
e)
φ (degree)
KMAI
/K0I<1
(shielding)
Figure 6.27 The phase diagram of amplification and shielding effects of main crack due to the presence of a unique microcrack using 0th-order and 1st-order approximate solution.
6.5.4 Finite Element Analysis of Two Models
The approximate solutions proposed in the literature (Gong and Horii, 1989; Rose, 1986) were
developed based on the assumption of 1/ >cd (Figure 6.25), when 1/ ≤cd , the results are
invalid. If cd / is close to 1, these methods become impractical because many higher orders of
expansion are necessary to achieve reasonable accuracy. In addition, these analytic solutions are
derived in the situation that the elastic solid containing the main crack/microcracks is infinite.
However, the two models deal with an elastic solid with a specific geometry of a half disc. In
these cases, finite element analysis can be a good alternative and this fact has been confirmed by
Meguid et al. (1991).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 184
Herein, finite element analysis is carried out using ANSYS software. Taking advantage of the
symmetry of both models, half-crack model is used to build the finite element model. PLANE82
(eight-node) element is used in the analysis. To better simulate the stress singularity of r -1/2 near
the crack tip (r is the radius to the crack tip), 1/4 nodal element (singular element) (Barsoum,
1977) is applied to mesh the vicinity of the crack tip. Theoretically, the stress intensity factor can
be calculated from either the stress field or displacement field near the tip of the crack. Since the
stress field in ANSYS is deduced from the displacement field, the stress intensity factor is
calculated based on the displacement field in the vicinity of the crack tip. A loading force of 200
N is applied to the finite element model; and the Young’s modulus is taken as 80 GPa and the
Possion’s ratio is 0.21.
To first verify the accuracy of our numerical calculation, a semi-infinite main crack with one
collinear microcrack under Mode I loading (correspond to the case of 0==θφ in 6Figure 6.27) is
considered as a testing problem. The exact solution (Rose, 1986) of this problem is given below,
where )(kK and )(kE denote the complete elliptic integrals of the first kind and the second kind
respectively (Abramowitz and Stegun, 1972).
)'()(
0 kkk
KK
I
MAI
Κ⋅Ε
= (6.36)
where, cdcdk
+−
= 21' kk −=
The calculated stress intensity factor via ANSYS are normalized by 0IK and compared with the
exact results (Gong and Horii, 1989) for different cases of d/c in 6Table 6.4. The meshed elements
are between 1663 and 2139; the nodes are between 5032 and 6486. The maximum error as
tabulated in 6Table 6.4 is less than 1.03 %, which occurs when d/c=1.1
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 185
Table 6.4 Stress intensity factor of the main crack with one collinear microcrack at different
distances to the main crack tip.
d/c 1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 2 3 Exact value 1.652 1.387 1.274 1.209 1.167 1.076 1.030
ANSYS value 1.635 1.398 1.287 1.221 1.176 1.086 1.024 Error (%) -1.029 0.721 1.020 0.992 0.771 0.999 -0.582
Error (%) =100× (ANSYS value- Exact value)/ Exact value
In the following numerical analysis, the phenomena of stress shielding and stress amplification
due to crack/microcrack interaction are quantified. Three numerical models are built to achieve
this goal: 1) Intact Model, corresponding to the microcrack-free case ( 6Figure 6.28), 2) Model 1,
corresponding to Case 1 (6Figure 6.29), and 3) Model 2, corresponding to Case 2 ( 6Figure 6.30).
With the same boundary conditions, the stress intensity factor 0IK for Intact Model, 1M
IK for
Model 1 and 2MIK for Model 2 can be calculated. 0
IK can be recognized as the far field loading.
For the microcrack-free case (Intact Model), a similar meshing scheme is used as reported before
( 6Figure 6.28). 6Figure 6.29 and 6Figure 6.30 show the meshing of our finite element Model 1 and
Model 2, respectively, in which 6Figure 6.29a and 6Figure 6.30a are the global meshes, featuring
increasing grids density towards the main crack tip; and 6Figure 6.29b and 6Figure 6.30b show the
mesh at the vicinity of the main crack and the microcracks for Model 1 and Model 2 respectively.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 186
Figure 6.28 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 1; Case 1 (b) close-view of the mesh at the vicinity of the main crack of the Intact Model. The main crack and its tip are indicated with arrows.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 187
Figure 6.29 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 1; Case 1 (b) close-view of the mesh at the vicinity of the main crack and the inclined microcrack of Model 1; Case 1. The main crack and its tip are indicated with arrows.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 188
Figure 6.30 Finite element mesh (a) global mesh of Model 2; Case 2 (b) close-view of the mesh at the vicinity of the main crack and the collinear microcrack of Model 2; Case 2. The main crack and its tip are indicated with arrows and the collinear microcrack is also marked.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 189
6Figure 6.31, 6Figure 6.32 and 6Figure 6.33 compare the stress intensity (i.e. the stress difference
between the maximum and minimum principal stress) contours around the main crack tip. 6Figure
6.31 shows the stress intensity contours near the tip of the main crack in the absence of
microcracks, in which case 0IK is evaluated. 6Figure 6.32 shows the stress intensity contours due
to the presence of two symmetric microcracks in Case 1. 6Figure 6.33 shows the magnified view
of the stress intensity contours due to the presence of a collinear microcrack in Case 2. Nine
contour lines denoted by A to I, represent the stress intensity values from 40,000 Pa to 200,000
Pa with a stress increment of 20,000 Pa. These contour lines indicate the concentrated stress
distribution of stress field near the tip of the crack: the closer to the tip of the crack, the higher
the stress intensity.
Figure 6.31 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories at the vicinity of the main crack for the semi-circular band specimen in the absence of microcracks.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 190
Figure 6.32 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories of the main crack and the inclined microcrack of the semi-circular bend specimen in Model 1.
Figure 6.33 The deformation and stress intensity trajectories of the main crack and the collinear microcrack of the semi-circular bend specimen in Model 2.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 191
Examining these contours, it can be seen that the microcracks in Model 1 tend to decrease the
intensity of the stress field of the main crack, thus yielding stress shielding effect of the main
crack; whereas for Model 2, the microcrack tends to increase the intensity of the stress field of
the main crack, thus yielding stress amplification of the main crack. This can be judged by
comparing the distance of the crack tip to the contour with the same stress level.
The finite element calculations can quantify the shielding or amplification effects for both cases.
Within the framework of linear elastic fracture mechanics (LEFM), only the ratio between stress
intensity factors is required in this study: 01 / IMI KK is 0.880 (shielding) for Model 1 and
02 / IMI KK is 1.233 (amplification) for Model 2. The quantification of shielding or amplification
effects using finite element analysis can help interpret the anisotropy of measured fracture
toughness in the experiments.
For the dynamic fracture tests conducted in the modified SHPB system with careful pulse
shaping, it has been proved in the previous section that for the Intact Model, the microcrack-free
case, as long as the dynamic force balance has been achieved on both ends of the NSCB sample,
the time-varying SIF deduced from the quasi-static data analysis is the same as that from a full
dynamic analysis. Following the same strategy, Model 1 and Model 2 will be examined as well.
Dynamic finite element analysis are carried out on Model 1 and Model 2 to determine the SIF
evolution by solving the equation of motion with Newmark time integration method in ANSYS
(Weisbrod and Rittel, 2000). The finite element meshing for Model 1 and Model 2 is the same as
that for 6Figure 6.29 and 6Figure 6.30, while taking the input loading F1 and F2 as half of the
dynamic loading forces exerted on the incident and transmitted side of the sample, respectively.
For pulse shaped SHPB tests, dynamic force balance can also be achieved (i.e. F1= F2), thus in
the finite element analysis, the bearing load (e.g. F2) is applied on both loading ends of the
sample. As demonstration, a typical dynamic load as shown in 6Figure 6.34 has been applied to
all three finite element models (i.e., Intact, Model 1 and Model 2). This time-varying load comes
from an actual measurement in a typical dynamic NSCB test with force balance achieved on both
ends of the sample.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 192
0 50 100 150 200
0
1
2
3
4
Forc
e (k
N)
Time (μs)
Figure 6.34 The dynamic load exerted on both ends of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), the load comes from an actual measurement in a modified SHPB tests with force balance achieved on both ends of the sample.
For the three finite element models (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), the SIF evolutions calculated
by dynamic finite element analysis are compared with that from a quasi-static analysis in 6Figure
6.35. For all three models (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), the evolutions of SIFs from both static
and dynamic methods match reasonably well. Therefore, with remote force balance, the static
analysis can fully reproduce the transient SIF evolution of the main crack tip for all three models.
Recall that the static SIF evolution is proportional to the bearing load (e.g. F2) according to the
static equation which can be calibrated with static finite element analysis (6Figure 6.29 and 6Figure
6.30). Thus, at any instant throughout the loading, 01 / IMI KK is 0.880 (shielding) for Model 1,
and 02 / IMI KK is 1.233 (amplification) for Model 2.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 193
0 50 100 150 200
0
1
2
3
4
5
SIF
(MP
a m
1/2 )
Time (μs)
Intact_Dynamic Intact_Static Model 1_Dynamic Model 1_Static Model 2_Dynamic Model 2_Static
Figure 6.35 The evolution of SIF of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2) from both quasi-static analysis and dynamic analysis; force balance has been guaranteed using a modified SHPB tests with careful pulse shaping.
It is also noted that for each test, the loading rate is determined as the slope of the pre-peak linear
portion of the SIF evolution. Thus, the ratio of the loading rate for Model 1 and Model 2 to the
loading rate for the Intact Model should be ••
01/ II KK is 0.880 (shielding) for Model 1 and ••
02 / II KK =1.233 (amplification) for Model 2.
This can be proven as follows. Assume there is a linearly increased force as shown in 6Figure
6.36 exerted on both ends of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and
Model 2) under force balance. Using dynamic finite element analysis aforementioned, the
evolution of the dynamic dimensionless SIF Y (normalized by 2/3/ BRPS , see Figure 6.13) and
corresponding loading rates of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and
Model 2) can be calculated, as illustrated in 6Figure 6.37. The loading rate for each case, as
denoted by the slope of the dashed line, exhibits exactly the same ratio of 01 / IMI KK equals to
0.880 for Model 1 (shielding), and 02 / IMI KK equals to 1.233 for Model 2 (amplification).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 194
0 20 40 60 80 1000
50
100
150
200
Forc
e (N
)
Time (μs)
Figure 6.36 The linear load exerted on both ends of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2), assuming force balance on both loading ends of the sample.
0 20 40 60 80 1000.0
0.2
0.4
0.6
0.8
1.0
1.2
1.4Model 2
Model 1
Y
Time (μs)
Intact_Dynamic Intact_Slope Model 1_Dynamic Model 1_Slope Model 2_Dynamic Model 2_Slope Intact
Figure 6.37 The evolution of the dynamic dimensionless SIFs and corresponding loading rates of the NSCB specimen for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2) with linear dynamic loading, assuming force balance on both loading ends of the sample.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 195
6.5.5 Simulated Fracture Toughness Anisotropy
All of the rock fracture toughness measurement methods including those proposed by ISRM are
based on the linear elastic fracture mechanics (LEFM) theory, in which the fracture toughness is
considered to be unique and the crack of the rock sample initiates when the stress intensity factor
at the main crack reaches the fracture toughness. By recording the loading exerted on the
samples in the experiments, fracture toughness can be calculated based on proposed formulas.
For convinience, in the crack/microcracks configurations, the ratio of the local stress intensity
factor at the main crack tip and the loading is denoted byξ (i.e. ξ=0/ ILI KK ). Thus, 1=ξ
corresponds to the microcrack-free case. 1>ξ corresponds to the stress amplification where the
stress intensity factor of the main crack is increased due to the presence of microcracks. 1<ξ ,
corresponds to the stress shielding where the stress intensity factor of the main crack decreased
due to the presence of microcracks
For the SHPB tests for dynamic Mode-I fracture toughness characterization, the observed rate
dependence of fracture toughness anisotropy can also be interpreted using the proposed models,
but rather more complicated than the static case. This is because the dynamic fracture toughness
is no longer considered to be a unique value; in contrast, it is recognized to be dependent on the
loading rates. As proven before with dynamic finite element analysis, the ratio of the SIF loading
rate at the main crack tip and the loading is the same as the ratio of the local SIF at the main
crack tip to the loading at the same loading rate, i.e. ξ=0/ ILI KK and ξ=
••0/ I
LI KK .
Let 0ICK be the measured Mode-I fracture toughness (the global fracture toughness) of rocks from
the material testing device (either the material testing machine or SHPB system) based on the
maximum value of load, if a quasi-static state has been guaranteed. 0ICK is the maximum
apparent value of 0IK measured during material testing, which is usually considered to be ICK .
Experimental methods for measuring fracture toughness of rocks never “see” the effect of
microcracks on the disturbance of the local stress intensity field of the main crack. If 1≠ξ ,
during the experiment, the local stress intensity factor LIK ( 0
IK⋅= ξ ) increases with the loading 0IK until the L
IK is equal to the fracture toughness ICK . Under this circumstance, if the
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 196
corresponding loading rate at far field is apparently•
0IK , then the local stress intensity factor L
IK
( 0IK⋅= ξ ) actually increases with a loading rate of
•
⋅ 0IKξ . Thus,
ξξ /)/max()max( 00IC
LIIIC KKKK === (6.37a)
ξ/0••
= LII KK (6.37b)
This suggests that the intrinsic material toughness (mircrocrack-free cases) and the measured
fracture toughness (microcracks embedded) are related:
0ICIC KK ⋅= ξ (6.38a)
••
⋅= 0IIC KK ξ (6.38a)
Given the relationship of the fracture toughness for mircrocracks-free case and the measured
fracture toughness for microcracks embedded cases, the apparent measured fracture toughness
for the adopted Model 1 and Model 2 can be calculated. Based on the experimental results, it is
assumed that the intrinsic dynamic Mode-I fracture toughness can be described with the data
points tabulated in 6Table 6.5, where fracture toughness ranges from 3.2 MPa.m1/2 to 8.5
MPa.m1/2 and corresponding loading rate ranges from 40 GPa.m1/2/s to 180 GPa.m1/2/s with an
increment of loading rate of 20 GPa.m1/2/s. This variation of dynamic fracture toughness
corresponds to the microcrack-free case with 1=ξ , as denoted before.
The measured toughness values and corresponding loading rates for Model 1 and Model 2 are
calculated and tabulated in 6Table 6.5; and also illustrated in 6Figure 6.38. It is obvious that Model
1 own the highest fracture toughness while Model 2, the least, at any given loading rates.
Physically, it is quite reasonable because, with collinear microcracks right in front of the
potential fracture path, Model 2 facilitates fracturing of rock pieces than the Model 1 case, with
microcracks inclined to the fracture path. In addition, the numerical simulation on the fracture
toughness of these two models in 6Figure 6.38 reflects that: 1) the rate of increment of the
dynamic fracture toughness with respect to the loading rate appear to be the same for Barre
granite samples along different groups; 2) the ranking of the six sample groups with respect to
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 197
the magnitude of the fracture toughness at any given loading rate remains the same for always.
These two scenarios reproduced what were observed in the experiments.
Table 6.5 The fracture toughness and corresponding loading rates for three models (Intact,
Model 1 and Model 2). Intact Model Model 1 Model 2
Loading Rates
(GPa.m1/2/s) Fracture Toughness
(MPa.m1/2) Loading Rates(GPa.m1/2/s)
Fracture Toughness(MPa.m1/2)
Loading Rates (GPa.m1/2/s)
Fracture Toughness(MPa.m1/2)
~0 1.2 ~0 1.4 ~0 1.0 40 3.2 45.5 3.6 32.4 2.6 60 4.0 68.2 4.5 48.7 3.2 80 4.7 90.9 5.3 64.9 3.8 100 5.5 113.6 6.3 81.1 4.5 120 6.2 136.4 7.0 97.3 5.0 140 7.0 159.1 8.0 113.5 5.7 160 7.7 181.8 8.8 129.8 6.2 180 8.5 204.5 9.7 146.0 6.9
0 40 80 120 160 200
2
4
6
8
10 Intact Model 1 Model 2
KIC
(MP
a m1/
2 )
KI (GPa m1/2 s-1)
Figure 6.38 The simulated dynamic fracture toughness of Barre granite with loading rates for three configurations (Intact, Model 1 and Model 2).
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 198
In the preceding chapter, the anisotropic index of Mode-I fracture toughness (αk) has been
defined as the ratio of the maximum fracture toughness to the minimum of fracture toughness.
Specifically in current numerical simulations, for static case, 01 / IMI KK =0.880 for Model 1 and
02 / IMI KK =1.233 for Model 2. Thus, during the experiments for fracture toughness
measurements, the measured fracture toughness for Model 1 should be
ICICMIC KKK 136.1880.0/1 == and that for Model 2 should be ICIC
MIC KKK 811.0233.1/2 == .
Thus, during static loading, the anisotropic index of Mode-I fracture toughness, αk
is 21 / MIC
MIC KK =1.136KIC/0.811KIC =1.40. For dynamic cases, the featuring loading rates are first
picked up and then the corresponding fracture toughness values at given selected loading rates
are deduced with interpolation within data points of Model 1 and Model 2, respectively.
Afterwards, αk can be calculated as the ratio of the toughness from Model 1 to that from Model 2
at giving loading rates. All related results are tabulated in 6Table 6.6.
Table 6.6 The simulated Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropic index (αk) of Barre granite
with loading rates.
Fracture Toughness (MPa.m1/2) Loading Rates (GPa.m1/2/s) Intact Model 1 Model 2
Anisotropy Index αk
~0 1.2 1.400 1.000 1.400 40 3.2 3.449 2.892 1.193 60 4.0 4.201 3.644 1.153 80 4.7 4.953 4.396 1.127
100 5.5 5.705 5.148 1.108 120 6.2 6.457 5.900 1.094 140 7.0 7.209 6.652 1.084 160 7.7 7.961 7.404 1.075 180 8.5 8.713 8.156 1.068 200 9.2 9.465 8.908 1.063
The variation of the anisotropic index of the simulated Mode-I fracture toughness, αk with
loading rates is also plotted in 6Figure 6.39. The data points of αk in 6Figure 6.39 drops quickly
approaching the isotropic value of 1. Thus, with proposed Models, the same trend of the loading
rate dependence of Mode-I fracture toughness has been reproduced as that reported previously in
the experimental characterizations, shown in 6Figure 6.22c.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 199
In real experimental tests for the two extreme cases corresponding to Model 1 and Model 2
shown in 6Figure 6.23 and 6Figure 6.24 respectively, the measured fracture toughness leads to an
anisotropic ratio of ~1.65. Although it is not intended to reproduce the exact ratio from
experiments by adjusting the geometrical parameters in these models, the numerical result yields
a very good agreement with experimental measurements.
Figure 6.39 The simulated Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropic index (αk) of Barre granite with loading rates based on crack-microcracks interaction model.
6.5.6 Concluding Remarks
Laboratory measurements of ICK of Barre granite under a wide range of loading rates were
carried out statically with MTS machine and dynamically with SHPB system. The fracture
toughness of the Barre granite investigated exhibited a decreasing anisotropy with the increase of
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 200
loading rates. Microstructural investigation of thin sections showed that there are three dominant
embedded microcracks orientated in preferred directions. The crack-microcrack interaction
model and its effect on the stress intensity factor of the main crack are used to explain this
loading rate dependence of Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropy.
Two models are constructed to investigate the influence of the stress intensity factor of the main
crack due to the presence of microcracks based on microscopic thin section pictures. Our finite
element analysis indicate that for the case of two symmetric microcracks near the vicinity of the
main crack (Model 1), the stress intensity factor is lower than the stress intensity factor of the
same main crack in the absence of microcracks (shielding); for the case of a collinear microcrack
near the main crack (Model 2), the stress intensity factor is higher than the stress intensity factor
of the same main crack in the absence of microcracks (amplification). Under our ideal
crack/microcrack models, the measured static fracture toughness could be different by a factor of
1.40; while in the dynamic case, for example, under a loading rate of 200 GPa.m1/2/s, the factor
decreases to 1.063.
In engineering design against fracture failure, the intrinsic fracture toughness is one of the key
parameters. For rocks with pre-existing microcracks, the measured fracture toughness is not
necessarily the intrinsic fracture material toughness ICK as discussed before. If the measured
fracture toughness value corresponding to stress shielding case is used, the design tends to be
overly aggressive; if the measured fracture toughness value corresponding to stress amplification
is used, the design tends to be overly conservative. However, it is able to deduce the intrinsic
fracture toughness ICK combining with the microstructural analysis of the rock sample and
numerical simulation. It is then feasible to use ICK and in-situ microstructural analysis to
determine the global fracture toughness LoadIK and make our design accordingly. As a result,
different toughness values will be used in different directions and these values can be evaluated
easily with ξ evaluated from numerical analysis and the relation of ξ/ICLoadI KK = . On the other
hand, under very higher loading rates, the apparent measured fracture toughness only has
negligible difference with the intrinsic dynamic fracture toughness. The material appears to be
isotropic in the perspective of practical significance.
CHAPTER 6: DYNAMIC FRACTURE TESTS 201
6.6 Summary
In this Chapter, a dynamic NSCB method is proposed in conjunction with the LGG system
(Chen et al., 2009) to measure the dynamic fracture toughness and fracture energy of rocks.
Because the quasi-static analysis can be carried out independently of the detailed forms of the
loading history, the dynamic NSCB method thus provides a much more convenient way to
quantify the dynamic fracture toughness of brittle materials such as rocks.
To validate the new method, the inertial effect in the dynamic NSCB test of rocks using SHPB is
systematically examined. It was found that without pulse shaping, the dynamic forces on both
ends of the specimen are very different. The resulting inertial effect causes two peaks in the
transmitted force pulse, and a huge delay of the peak transmitted force with respect to the crack
onset. The SIF history obtained from a full dynamic finite element analysis is very different from
that obtained from a quasi-static analysis using the transmitted dynamic force as loads. With
careful pulse shaping, the dynamic force balance for the entire dynamic loading period can be
achieved. In this case, the peak far-field load matches with the fracture onset reasonably well. In
addition, the SIF history obtained from full dynamic finite element analysis agrees well with that
from quasi-static analysis. It is thus verified that with far-field force balance, the inertial effect is
minimized and quasi-static analysis is thus valid to deduce the fracture toughness.
The new method is then applied to research on the fracture properties of anisotropic Barre
granite under both static and dynamic loadings. Rate dependence of the fracture toughness and
fracture energy of Barre granite is observed. The Barre granite exhibits strong fracture toughness
anisotropy under static loading and diminishing anisotropy in dynamic loading. Under high
loading rates, it is anticipated that the fracture toughness anisotropy can be ignored. The rate
dependence of the anisotropy is explained with proposed microcrack interaction models, built
from microstructural investigation of two thin sections showing the pre-existing microcracks
orientated in preferred directions. These two thin sections are taken from recovered Barre granite
samples in two different groups with distinct measured fracture toughness. The crack microcrack
interaction models reproduced the apparent rate dependence of fracture toughness anisotropy.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 202
CHAPTER 7
SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK
This chapter summarizes the overall conclusions of the thesis from the preceding chapters.
Future work is also outlined.
7.1 Summary of the Thesis Work
This thesis investigated the anisotropy of tension-related failure parameters, i.e. tensile strength,
flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness/fracture energy of anisotropic Barre granite
under a wide range of loading rates, and explored the relationship between the fabric of
preferentially embedded microcracks in the Barre granite and the measured anisotropy of these
physical properties.
The following lines summarize the main items completed in this thesis and the major
concussions:
• Three sets of dynamic experimental methodologies involving experimentation and
calculation equations using the modified dynamic testing machine, i.e. SHPB system, are
developed to measure the dynamic tension-related mechanical properties of rocks. These
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 203
methods are: the dynamic BD method to determine the dynamic tensile strength of rocks,
the dynamic SCB method to determine the dynamic flexural strength of rocks, and the
dynamic NSCB method to determine the dynamic Mode-I fracture toughness of rocks. The
samples chosen are all core-based, facilitating sample preparation from rock blocks. The
data reduction is readily applicable for employing quasi-static equations to the dynamic
tests, provided that the time-resolved dynamic forces are balanced at both loading ends of
the BD, SCB and NSCB samples.
• The reliability and robustness of the proposed dynamic testing methodologies, for dynamic
tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness characterization are
rigorously validated. To do so, both pulse shaped and non-pulse shaped tests were
conducted to assess under which circumstance the proposed dynamic testing methods are
valid. A strain gauge was mounted near the failure spot or crack tip on the specimen to
determine the onset instant of fracture. It was demonstrated that in a modified SHPB test
with proper pulse shaping, the dynamic force balance within the sample is achieved. Thus,
the tensile stress at the failure spot or the Mode-I SIF at the crack tip in the sample can be
calculated with either quasi-static analysis or dynamic finite element analysis using the far-
field measurements as inputs. Moreover, the rupture time synchronizes with the peak of the
transmitted pulse recorded in the SHPB system after corrections for travel time. Therefore,
the dynamic tensile strength, flexural strength and fracture toughness can be calculated
from the peak of the transmitted wave measured in the SHPB system with quasi-static
analysis.
• The loading rate dependence of the tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture
toughness and fracture energy of Barre granite has been observed along all six directions.
Take sample XY for example, the tensile strength under a quasi-static loading rate of 1.8E-
4 GPa/s is 9.5 MPa, while under dynamic loading rate up to 1500 GPa/s, the tensile
strength is 38.2 MPa, four times of the static strength; the static flexural strength of XY is
13.5 MPa under a loading rate of 8E-4 GPa/s, while the dynamic flexural strength is 54.8
MPa, also four times of the static tensile strength, with a dynamic loading rate ~1800
GPa/s; the static Mode-I fracture toughness of XY is 1.03 MPa·m1/2 under loading rate of
~8E-5 MPa·m1/2s-1; and the dynamic counterpart is more than seven times of the static one
(i.e. 7.8 MPa·m1/2), under a loading rate of 180 MPa·m1/2s-1.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 204
• The flexural strengths of Barre granite along all six directions are consistently higher than
the tensile strength measured from Brazilian tests in both static test and dynamic tests. The
tensile stress gradient along the potential failure path is believed to be the main reason of
this distinction, since the tensile strength is defined under a homogeneous tensile stress
state. A non-local failure theory is adopted to qualitatively explain the differences of the
measured strengths; and the gap between these two is bridged as well. This can be done by
determining the ratio κ (i.e. σf /σt) first by comparing the static flexural strength to the static
tensile strength. Then this ratio κ can be utilized to reconcile the dynamic tensile strength
from the measured dynamic flexural strength, compared with the direct measures of
dynamic tensile strengths from Brazilian tests for all six sample directions. The reconciled
tensile strength from flexural strength matches very well with the tensile strength from
direct measures via Brazilian tests.
• Under static loading, Barre granite exhibits strong anisotropy for the three tension-related
parameters, i.e. tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness. For the
static case, the tensile strength anisotropic index equals to 1.83, with the highest strength of
16.8 MPa for samples splitting in the plane normal to Z axis; and the lowest of 9.2 MPa
with splitting plane normal to X axis. The flexural strength anisotropic index equals to 1.86,
with the highest strength of 24.6 MPa for samples splitting in the plane normal to Z axis;
and the lowest of 13.2 MPa with splitting plane normal to X axis. Under static loading, the
fracture toughness index equals to 1.70, as the loading rate is up to 220 MPa·m1/2s-1, the
index drops to 1.20; the maximum fracture toughness remains still in samples ZX and the
lowest one is fixed in samples XY for both cases.
• Under dynamic loading, in sharp contrast to the static loading, Barre granite exhibits much
weaker anisotropy for the three tension-related parameters, i.e. tensile strength, flexural
strength and Mode-I fracture toughness. The anisotropic index of 1) tensile strength drops
drastically to the dynamic value of 1.13 with a loading rate of 1800 GPa/s; 2) flexural
strength drops to 1.24 under a loading rate of 2000 GPa/s; 3) Mode-I fracture toughness
drops to 1.20, as the loading rate is up to 220 MPa·m1/2s-1. The tensile strength, flexural
strength and Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropy of Barre granite appears to be strong
under quasi-static loading while rather weak under dynamic loading rates.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 205
• It is identified that anisotropy of the mechanical properties explored in this research is
correlated closely to the preferentially oriented microcracks sets. With reference to the
dominant three sets of microcracks in Chapter 3, YZ plane is recognized to be parallel to
the rift plane with the dominant microcracks, and XZ is the secondary concentration of
microcracks for Barre granite. The YZ plane, XZ plane and XY plane correspond to the
quarryman’s description of “rift plane”, “grain plane” and “hard-way plane” respectively.
This explains that in our static tests of tensile strength flexural strength and Mode-I
fracture toughness measurements, the minimum strength or toughness is obtained from
sample XY and XZ, both split in the rift plane YZ (normal to X axis), while the maximum
are obtained from sample ZX and ZY with a hard-way splitting plane XY (normal to Z
axis).
• Qualitative interpretation on the anisotropy of tensile strength and flexural strength has
been given. When a rock sample with an array of cracks is loaded statically, the critical
flaw or crack will dominate the response of the rock, yielding the maximum bearing load.
If a preferred orientation of the largest flaws exists, the material will also show a
dependence on the orientation for the fracture stress. In contrast, the dynamic load is
qualitatively very different from static load. Given the rapid, short time loading, only a
small volume V of the sample is indeed stressed to a high value and this volume is not
tremendously affected by its neighboring volumes. This will lead to a less anisotropy of the
dynamic rock tensile/flexural strength.
• The crack-microcrack interaction model is utilized to reproduce the apparent rate
dependence of Mode-I fracture toughness anisotropy. Two models were built from
microstructural investigation of thin sections showing the pre-existing microcracks
orientated in preferred directions. The two thin sections were taken from recovered Barre
granite fracture samples along two directions with distinct measured fracture toughness.
Both analytical and numerical analysis reveled that the stress intensity of the main crack
tends to be shielded due to the microcracks at an angle of o45 to main crack, while the
stress intensity of main crack is amplified as it is collinear to microcracks. The measured
fracture toughness is reversely proportional to the shield/amplification effects due to the
microcracks, and this yields the apparent fracture toughness anisotropy for the two models.
By the same token, a dynamic analysis was conducted employing the same models. Using
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 206
the crack-microcrack interacting models, the trend of the rate dependence of fracture
toughness for the two cases is reconstructed, from which, descending fracture toughness
anisotropy with ascending loading rates was also explicitly reproduced. In addition, the
models explained why the rate of increment of the dynamic fracture toughness with respect
to the loading rate appears to be the same for Barre granite samples along different groups.
7.2 Future Work
A straightforward extension of current research is the measurement of the fracture surface
topology, e.g. surface roughness and fractal dimensions, of the newly generated fracture surfaces
of Barre granite samples recovered from the dynamic tensile test, dynamic flexural test and the
dynamic Mode-I fracture tests. The employed novel technique on SHPB, i.e. Momentum Trap
technique, prohibits multiple loading to the sample, and thus makes it possible to quantitatively
relate the surface topology to the loading. The objective of this investigation is twofold: first, to
examine the relation between these mechanical properties (i.e. tensile strength, flexural strength
and Mode-I fracture toughness) and fracture surface topology as a function of loading rates; and
second, to look into the loading rate dependence of fracture surface topology anisotropy of the
Barre granite using the tested samples on six directions preserved after the dynamic tensile,
flexural and Mode-I fracture toughness tests.
Apart from this, two other motivating branches of interest can be directed to systematically and
thoroughly investigate the environmental influences involving confining effects and thermal
effects on the mechanical properties of rocks in general and anisotropic Barre granite in specific.
Both confining effects and thermal effects may influence the mechanical properties of rocks
through its microcracks.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 207
7.2.1 Confining Effects
It has been well-known that the rock strength properties are markedly influenced by the
confining pressure. The rock strength characterization under lateral confinement is thus
important to actually understand the mechanism of rock behaviors in engineering applications.
The quasi-static triaxial test on rocks is mature and has already been standardized by ISRM
(Vogler and Kovari, 1978).
Experiments have also been carried out to study the strain rate effects on rock material properties
in the triaxial compression (Li et al., 1999; Masuda et al., 1987; Sangha and Dhir, 1975; Yang
and Li, 1994). While most believe that as the confining pressure increases, the strength of rocks
increases more when the strain rates increases up to the same order of magnitude (Masuda et al.,
1987; Sangha and Dhir, 1975). Others reported that the strength increment is less under a higher
confining pressure as the strain rate increases under the same range, such as Sangha and Dhir
(1975) on a sandstone and Yang and Li (1994) on a granite. The opposing results reveal that the
rate of increase of the mechanical properties of rocks could be different for different rocks and
different confining pressure; and exactly these contrasting observations inspire the curiosity to
look into the anisotropic Barre granite.
The strain rates achieved in these tests are between 10-7 to 100/s, limited by the dynamic testing
machine used. To achieve higher strain rates, triaxial Hopkinson method has been adopted to
simultaneously subject the samples to lateral confinement and axial loading (Nemat-Nasser et al.,
2000). Christensen (1972) pioneered the usage of triaxial Hopkinson method on rock testing. The
lateral compression was mostly applied through a pneumatic pressure vessel; and a similar vessel
is to be employed in our SHPB design to accommodate the dynamic tensile tests via BD sample,
flexural tests via SCB samples and fracture tests via NSCB samples. As an example, 6Figure 7.1
illustrates the design of the dynamic Brazilian test under hydrostatic confining pressure on SHPB
system; the pneumatic pressure vessel is filled with high pressured oil. The BD sample can be
replaced with the other two types of samples.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 208
Figure 7.1 Schematic of the Brazilian test under hydrostatic confining pressure on SHPB system.
It is aimed at in the near future to further investigate the effects of confining pressure on the
tensile strength, flexural strength and Mode-I fracture toughness of anisotropic Barre granite
under dynamic loading cases. The objective of this research is threefold: 1) to develop a set of
reliable triaxial Hopkinson bar methods to conduct strength and toughness measurements of
rocks under high loading rates; 2) to study the effects of the confining pressure and the coupled
effects of the confining pressure and loading rates on the anisotropy of material properties of
Barre granite; 3) to correlate the properties to the microstructure of Barre granite and look into
the micro-mechanism of the observations.
7.2.2 Thermal Effects
Temperature variation occurs as a company of a variety of rock engineering practices, such as
rock cutting, drilling, blasting and fragmentation, ore crushing, tunneling boring, etc. It has been
recognized that temperature markedly influences the mechanical properties of rocks (Duclos and
Paquet, 1991; Homandetienne and Houpert, 1989; Inada and Yokota, 1984; Nasseri et al., 2007;
Wai et al., 1982), such as coefficient of thermal expansion, Young’s modulus, Poisson’s ratio,
the compressive/tensile strength and fracture toughness; in addition, different heating/cooling
rates yields different changes to the mechanical properties.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 209
The research on the coupled effects of temperature and loading rates on the mechanical
properties of rocks has been rarely reported in the literature. Several pioneering attempts are as
follows. Lindholm (1974) constructed the relationship between rock strength, temperature and
the strain rate. Zhang et al. (2001) extended their early works (Zhang et al., 2001) to investigate
the dynamic fracture toughness of a gabbro and a marble subjected to two cases of thermal
circumstances: case 1, samples are tested at high temperature; case 2, samples are pre-heat
treated at varying high temperatures.
Given available investigations in the literature, the effect of temperature on the dynamic tensile
strength and flexural strength of rocks are missing. As well, there is no research on the
mechanical properties, e.g. tensile strength, flexural strength and fracture toughness of
anisotropic rock like Barre granite under a wide range of loading rates. With current available
novel techniques on SHPB, it is time to initiate the study in these areas.
It is of interest to investigate thermal effects on the dynamic tensile strength, flexural strength
and fracture toughness of anisotropic Barre granite. Two types of thermal effects will be
considered: 1) pre-heat treated 2) in-situ heating. For case 1, three types of Barre granite samples
(BD, SCB, and NSCB) along six directions are first pre-heat treated at varying high temperature,
say 200 ˚C, 400 ˚C, 600 ˚C and 800 ˚C. After all cooled down to the room temperature, these
samples are used to conduct the SHPB tests as discussed before. For case 2, a schematic of the
modified SHPB design for conducting dynamic Brazilian tests with in-situ heating is illustrated
in 7Figure 7.2. This modified SHPB system can also host the flexural test using SCB samples and
Mode-I fracture tests using NSCB samples.
Figure 7.2 Schematic of the Brazilian test on SHPB system under in-situ thermal heating.
CHAPTER 7: SUMMARY AND FUTURE WORK 210
For both thermal conditions proposed herein, different heating/cooling rates may be tried as well
to look into the dependence of this on the material properties. This research is expected to
understand the relationship between the thermal cracking on the host rock physics and the
mechanical properties under a wide range of loading rates. The first exploration of the anisotropy
of Barre granite on these mechanical properties due to thermal cracking under a wide range of
loading rates is also of primary interest in the near future.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 211
BIBLIOGRAPHY
Abramowitz, M. and Stegun, I.A., 1972. Handbook of Mathematical Funtions. Dover Publications, Inc.New York, 1046 pp.
Anderson, T.L., 2005. Fracture Mechanics: Fundamentals and Applications. CRC Taylor & Francis, New York.
Aravani, M. and Ferdowsi, B., 2006. Evaluating the semi-circular bend test as a new method to determine tensile strength of asphalt concrete mixture, 7th International Congress on Civil Engineering, Tarbaiat Modarres University, Tehran, Iran.
Ashby, M.F. and Sammis, C.G., 1990. The Damage Mechanics of Brittle Solids in Compression. Pure and Applied Geophysics, 133(3): 489-521.
ASTM C99 / C99M-09, 2009. Standard Test Method for Modulus of Rupture of Dimension Stone. ASTM International.
ASTM C880 / C880M-09, 2009. Standard Test Method for Flexural Strength of Dimension Stone. ASTM International.
ASTM Standard C78-09, 2009. Standard Test Method for Flexural Strength of Concrete (Using Simple Beam with Third-Point Loading). ASTM International.
ASTM Standard C293-07, 2007. Standard Test Method for Flexural Strength of Concrete (Using Simple Beam with Center-Point Loading). ASTM International.
ASTM Standard E399-09, 2009. Standard Test Method for Linear-Elastic Plane-Strain Fracture Toughness KIc of Metallic materials. ASTM International.
Atkinson, C., Smelser, R.E. and Sanchez, J., 1982. Combined Mode Fracture Via the Cracked Brazilian Disk Test. International Journal of Fracture, 18(4): 279-291.
Awaji, H. and Sato, S., 1978. Combined Mode Fracture Toughness Measurement by Disk Test. Journal of Engineering Materials and Technology-Transactions of the Asme, 100(2): 175-182.
Böhme, W., 1988. The Influence of Stress Wave on the Dynamic Crack Tip Loading in Three-Point Bend Impact Testing. Impact Loading and Dynamic Behavior of Materials, C. Y. Chiem, H.-D. Kunze, and L. W. Meyer, eds., DGM Informationsgesellschaft, Verlag, West Germany: 305-311.
Böhme, W. and Kalthoff, J.F., 1982. The behavior of notched bend specimens in impact testing. International Journal of Fracture, 20(4): R139-R143.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 212
Backers, T., Fardin, N., Dresen, G. and Stephansson, O., 2003. Effect of loading rate on Mode I fracture toughness, roughness and micromechanics of sandstone. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 40(3): 425-433.
Bacon, C., 1993. Mesure de la tenacite dynamique de materiaux fragiles enflexion-trois-points ahaute temperature-Utilisation des barres de Hopkinson. Ph.D. thesis, University of Bordeaux, France.
Bacon, C., Farm, J. and Lataillade, J.L., 1994. Dynamic Fracture-Toughness Determined from Load-Point Displacement. Experimental Mechanics, 34(3): 217-223.
Barla, G., 1974. Rock anisotropy: Theory and laboratory testing, Rock Mechanics. L. Muller. Springer-Verlag, New York, 132-169 pp.
Barsoum, R.S., 1977. Triangular Quarter-Point Elements as Elastic and Perfectly-Plastic Crack Tip Elements. International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, 11(1): 85-98.
Bazant, Z.P., Bai, S.P. and Gettu, R., 1993. Fracture of Rock - Effect of Loading Rate. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 45(3): 393-398.
Berenbaum, R. and Brodie, I., 1959. The tensile strength of coal. Journal of the Institute of Fuel, 32(222): 320-327.
Bergmann, G. and Vehoff, H., 1994. Precracking of Nial Single-Crystals by Compression-Compression Fatigue and Its Application to Fracture-Toughness Testing. Scripta Metallurgica Et Materialia, 30(8): 969-974.
Bertram, A. and Kalthoff, J.F., 2003. Crack propagation toughness of rock for the range of low to very high crack speeds. In: F.G. Buchholz, H.A. Richard and M.H. Aliabadi (Editors), Advances in Fracture and Damage Mechanics Key engineering materials. Trans Tech Publications, Uetikon-Zurich, pp. 423-430.
Bieniawski, Z.T. and Bernede, M.J., 1979. Suggested methods for determining the uniaxial compressive strength and deformability of rock Materials. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 16(2): 137-138.
Bieniawski, Z.T. and Hawkes, I., 1978. Suggested methods for determining tensile strength of rock materials. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 15(3): 99-103.
Bohme, W. and Kalthoff, J.F., 1982. The behavior of notched bend specimens in impact testing. International Journal of Fracture, 20(4): R139-R143.
BS EN 12372, 1999. Natural stone test methods. Determination of flexural strength under concentrated load. British-Adopted European Standard.
BS EN 13161, 2008. Natural stone test methods. Determination of flexural strength under constant moment. British-Adopted European Standard.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 213
Bui, H.D., Maigre, H. and Rittel, D., 1992. A New Approach to the Experimental-Determination of the Dynamic Stress Intensity Factor. International Journal of Solids and Structures, 29(23): 2881-2895.
Cai, M., Kaiser, P.K., Suorineni, F. and Su, K., 2007. A study on the dynamic behavior of the Meuse/Haute-Marne argillite. Physics and Chemistry of the Earth, 32(8-14): 907-916.
Carter, B.J., 1992. Size and stress gradient effects on fracture around cavities. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, 25(3): 167-186.
Chang, S.H., Lee, C.I. and Jeon, S., 2002. Measurement of rock fracture toughness under modes I and II and mixed-mode conditions by using disc-type specimens. Engineering Geology, 66(1-2): 79-97.
Chen, C.H., Chen, C.S. and Wu, J.H., 2008. Fracture toughness analysis on cracked ring disks of anisotropic rock. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, 41(4): 539-562.
Chen, C.S., Pan, E. and Amadei, B., 1998a. Determination of deformability and tensile strength of anisotropic rock using Brazilian tests. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 35(1): 43-61.
Chen, C.S., Pan, E. and Amadei, B., 1998b. Fracture mechanics analysis of cracked discs of anisotropic rock using the boundary element method. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 35(2): 195-218.
Chen, R., Xia, K., Dai, F., Lu, F. and Luo, S.N., 2009. Determination of dynamic fracture parameters using a semi-circular bend technique in split Hopkinson pressure bar testing. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 76(9): 1268-1276.
Chen, W. and Ravichandran, G., 2000. Failure mode transition in ceramics under dynamic multiaxial compression. International Journal of Fracture, 101(1-2): 141-159.
Chen, W., Zhang, B. and Forrestal, M.J., 1999. A split Hopkinson bar technique for low-impedance materials. Experimental Mechanics, 39(2): 81-85.
Chen, W.N. and Ravichandran, G., 1996. Static and dynamic compressive behavior of aluminum nitride under moderate confinement. Journal of the American Ceramic Society, 79(3): 579-584.
Chen, W.N. and Ravichandran, G., 1997. Dynamic compressive failure of a glass ceramic under lateral confinement. Journal of the Mechanics and Physics of Solids, 45(8): 1303-1328.
Cho, S.H., Ogata, Y. and Kaneko, K., 2003. Strain-rate dependency of the dynamic tensile strength of rock. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 40(5): 763-777.
Chong, K.P. and Kuruppu, M.D., 1984. New specimen for fracture-toughness determination for rock and other materials. International Journal of Fracture, 26(2): R59-R62.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 214
Christensen, R.J., Swanson, S.R. and Brown, W.S., 1972. Split Hopkinson bar tests on rock under confining pressure. Experimental Mechanics, 12(11): 508-541.
Chudnovsky, A., Dolgopolsky, A. and Kachanov, M., 1987. Elastic Interaction of a Crack with a Microcrack Array .2. Elastic Solution for 2 Crack Configurations (Piecewise Constant and Linear-Approximations). International Journal of Solids and Structures, 23(1): 11-21.
Chudnovsky, A. and Kachanov, M., 1983. Interaction of a Crack with a Field of Microcracks. International Journal of Engineering Science, 21(8): 1009-1018.
Claussen, N., Steeb, J. and Pabst, R.F., 1977. Effect of Induced Microcracking on Fracture Toughness of Ceramics. American Ceramic Society Bulletin, 56(6): 559-562.
Corran, R.S.J., Benitez, F.G., Harding, J., Ruiz, C. and Nojima, T., 1983. Towards the Development of a Dynamic Fracture Initiation Test. Application of Fracture Mechanics to Materials and Structures, G. C. Sih, E. Sommer, and W. Dahl, eds., Martinus Nijhoff Publishers, The Hague: 443-454.
Costin, L.S., 1981. Static and dynamic fracture behaviour of oil shale. Fracture mechanics for ceramics, rock and concrete. ASTM STP745: 169-184.
Costin, L.S., Duffy, J. and Freund, L.B., 1976. Fracture initiation in metals under stress wave loading conditions. Brown University, Technical Report No. NSF Eng.: 75-09612/1.
Coviello, A., Lagioia, R. and Nova, R., 2005. On the measurement of the tensile strength of soft rocks. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, 38(4): 251-273.
Dai, F., Chen, R., Iqbal, M.J. and Xia, K.W., 2010a. Dynamic cracked chevron notched Brazilian disc method for measuring rock fracture parameters. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, doi:10.1016/j.ijrmms.2010.04.002.
Dai, F., Chen, R. and Xia, K., 2010b. A semi-circular bend technique for determining dynamic fracture toughness. Experimental Mechanics, doi:10.1007/s11340-009-9273-2.
Dai, F., Huang, S., Xia, K. and Tan, Z., 2010c. Some fundamental issues in dynamic compression and tension tests of rocks using split Hopkinson pressure bar. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, doi: 10.1007/s00603-010-0091-8.
Dai, F. and Xia, K., 2010. Loading Rate Dependence of Tensile strength anisotropy of Barre granite. Pure and Applied Geophysics, doi: 10.1007/s00024-010-0103-3.
Dai, F., Xia, K. and Luo, S.N., 2008. Semicircular bend testing with split Hopkinson pressure bar for measuring dynamic tensile strength of brittle solids. Review of Scientific Instruments, 79(12).
Dai, F., Xia, K.W. and Tang, L.Z., 2010d. Rate dependence of the flexural tensile strength of Laurentian granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 47(3): 469-475.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 215
Davies, R.M., 1948. A critical study of the Hopkinson pressure bar. Proceedings of the Royal Society A-Mathematical Physical and Engineering Sciences, A240: 375-457.
Dong, S.M., Wang, Y. and Xia, Y.M., 2004. Stress intensity factors for central cracked circular disk subjected to compression. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 71(7-8): 1135-1148.
Douglass, P.M. and Voight, B., 1969. Anisotropy of granites: a reflection of microscopic fabric. Geotechnique, 19(3): 376-379.
Duclos, R. and Paquet, J., 1991. High-Temperature Behavior of Basalts - Role of Temperature and Strain Rate on Compressive Strength and K-Ic Toughness of Partially Glassy Basalts at Atmospheric-Pressure. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 28(1): 71-76.
E399-06e2, A., 2006. Standard test method for plane strain fracture toughness of metallic materials. Annual book of ASTM Standards, 03(01).
Evans, A.G. and Faber, K.T., 1981. Toughening of Ceramics by Circumferential Microcracking. Journal of the American Ceramic Society, 64(7): 394-398.
Evans, I., 1961. The tensile strength of coal. Colliery Engineering, 38: 428-34.
Fischer, M.P., Elsworth, D., Alley, R.B. and Engelder, T., 1996. Finite element analysis of the modified ring test for determining mode I fracture toughness. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 33(1): 1-15.
Fowell, R.J., Hudson, J.A., Xu, C. and Chen, J.F., 1995. Suggested Method for Determining Mode-I Fracture-Toughness Using Cracked Chevron-Notched Brazilian Disc (Ccnbd) Specimens. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 32(1): 57-64.
Fowell, R.J. and Xu, C., 1993. The cracked chevron-notched brazilian disc test geometrical considerations for practical rock fracture toughness measurement. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 30(7): 821-824.
Fowell, R.J. and Xu, C., 1994. The Use of the Cracked Brazilian Disc Geometry for Rock Fracture Investigations. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 31(6): 571-579.
Frantz, C.E., Follansbee, P.S. and Wright, W.J., 1984. New experimental techniques with the split Hopkinson pressure bar. In: I. Berman and J.W. Schroeder (Editors), 8th International Conference on High Energy Rate Fabrication. ASME, San Antonio, pp. 17-21.
Freund, L.B., 1990. Dynamic fracture mechanics. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 563 pp.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 216
Frew, D.J., Forrestal, M.J. and Chen, W., 2001. A split Hopkinson pressure bar technique to determine compressive stress-strain data for rock materials. Experimental Mechanics, 41(1): 40-46.
Frew, D.J., Forrestal, M.J. and Chen, W., 2002. Pulse shaping techniques for testing brittle materials with a split Hopkinson pressure bar. Experimental Mechanics, 42(1): 93-106.
Frew, D.J., Forrestal, M.J. and Chen, W., 2005. Pulse shaping techniques for testing elastic-plastic materials with a split Hopkinson pressure bar. Experimental Mechanics, 45(2): 186-195.
Gandhi, K.R., 1972. Analysis of inclined crack centrally placed in an orthotropic rectangular plate. Journal of Strain Analysis, 7(3): 157-162.
Goldsmith, W., Sackman, J.L. and Ewert, C., 1976. Static and dynamic fracture strength of barre granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 13(11): 303-309.
Gong, S.X. and Horii, H., 1989. General-Solution to the Problem of Microcracks near the Tip of a Main Crack. Journal of the Mechanics and Physics of Solids, 37(1): 27-46.
Graff, K.F., 1975. Wave motion in elastic solids. Clarendon Press, Oxford, 649 pp.
Grantham, S.G., Siviour, C.R., Proud, W.G. and Field, J.E., 2004. High-strain rate Brazilian testing of an explosive simulant using speckle metrology. Measurement Science & Technology, 15(9): 1867-1870.
Gray, G.T., 2000. Classic split-Hopkinson pressure bar testing, ASM Handbook Vol 8, Mechanical Testing and Evaluation. ASM Int, Materials Park, OH, pp. 462-476.
Griffith, L.J. and Martin, D.J., 1974. Study of dynamic behavior of a carbon-fiber composite using split Hopkinson pressure bar. Journal of Physics D-Applied Physics, 7(17): 2329-2344.
Gunsallus, K.L. and Kulhawy, F.H., 1984. A Comparative-Evaluation of Rock Strength Measures. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 21(5): 233-248.
Guo, H., Aziz, N.I. and Schmidt, L.C., 1993. Rock Fracture-Toughness Determination by the Brazilian Test. Engineering Geology, 33(3): 177-188.
Hanson, J.H. and Ingraffea, A.R., 1997. Standards for fracture toughness testing of rock and manufactured ceramics: What can we learn for concrete? Cement Concrete and Aggregates, 19(2): 103-111.
Hardy, H.R. and Javaraman, N., 1970. An investigation of methods for the determination of tensile strength of rock. Proc. 2nd Conor. Int. Soc. Rock Mech. Part III, Belgrade, Yugoslavia: 85-92.
Hoagland, R.G., Hahn, G.T. and Rosenfield, A.R., 1973. Influence of Microstructure on the Fracture Propagation in Rock. Rock Mech., 5(2): 77-106.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 217
Hobbs, D.W., 1964. The strength and the stress strain characteristics of coal in triaxial compression. Journal of Geology, 72(2): 214-231.
Homandetienne, F. and Houpert, R., 1989. Thermally Induced Microcracking in Granites - Characterization and Analysis. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 26(2): 125-134.
Homma, H., Kanto, Y. and Tanaka, K., 1991. Cleavage Fracture under Short Pulse Loading. Journal De Physique Iii, 1(C3): 589-596.
Hopkinson, B., 1905. The Effects of Momentary Stresses in Metals. Proceedings of the Royal Society, A74: 498-506.
Hopkinson, B., 1914. A method of measuring the pressure produced in the detonation of high explosives or by the impact of bullets, Containing Papers of a Mathematical or Physical Character. Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society, London, pp. 437-456.
Hopkinson, J., 1872. Further experiments on the rupture of iron wire, Proc. Manchest. Liter. Philos. Soc., pp. 119-121.
Hopkinson, J., 1901. On the rupture of iron wire by a blow(1872). In: B. Hopkinson (Editor), Original Papers-by the late John Hopkinson. Cambridge Univ Press, pp. 316-320.
Horii, H. and Nemat-Nasser, S., 1985. Elastic Fields of Interacting Inhomogeneities. International Journal of Solids and Structures, 21(7): 731-745.
Horii, H. and Nemat-Nasser, S., 1986. Brittle Failure in Compression - Splitting, Faulting and Brittle-Ductile Transition. Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of London Series a-Mathematical Physical and Engineering Sciences, 319(1549): 337-374.
Hudson, J.A., 1969. Tensile strength and ring test. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 6(1): 91-97.
Hudson, J.A., Rummel, F. and Brown, E.T., 1972. The controlled failure of rock disks and rings loaded in diametral compression. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 9(2): 241-248.
Hughes, M.L., Tedesco, J.W. and Ross, C.A., 1993. Numerical Analysis of High Strain Rate Splitting Tensile Tests. Computers & Structures, 47(4-5): 653-671.
Hutchinson, J.W., 1987. Crack Tip Shielding by Microcracking in Brittle Solids. Acta Metallurgica, 35(7): 1605-1619.
Hutchinson, J.W., 1990. On Toughening by micocracks. Mechanics of Materials, 9: 83-91.
Inada, Y. and Yokota, K., 1984. Some Studies of Low-Temperature Rock Strength. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 21(3): 145-153.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 218
Ingraffea, A.R., Gunsallus, K.L., Beech, J.F. and Nelson, P.P., 1984. A short-rod based system for fracture toughness testing of rock. Chevron-notched specimens: testing and stress analysis., ASTM STP 855, American Society for Testing and Materials, pp. 152-166.
Iqbal, M.J. and Mohanty, B., 2007. Experimental calibration of ISRM suggested fracture toughness measurement techniques in selected brittle rocks. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, 40(5): 453-475.
Irfan, M.A. and Prakash, V., 2000. Dynamic deformation and fracture behavior of novel damage tolerant discontinuously reinforced aluminum composites. International Journal of Solids and Structures, 37(33): 4477-4507.
Isida, M., 1975. Arbitrary loading problems of doubly symmetric regions containing a central crack. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 7: 505-514.
Jiang, F.C., Liu, R.T., Zhang, X.X., Vecchio, K.S. and Rohatgi, A., 2004a. Evaluation of dynamic fracture toughness K-Id by Hopkinson pressure bar loaded instrumented Charpy impact test. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 71(3): 279-287.
Jiang, F.C., Rohatgi, A., Vecchio, K.S. and Cheney, J.L., 2004b. Analysis of the dynamic responses for a pre-cracked three-point bend specimen. International Journal of Fracture, 127(2): 147-165.
Jiang, F.C. and Vecchio, K.S., 2007a. Dynamic effects in Hopkinson bar four-point bend fracture. Metallurgical and Materials Transactions a-Physical Metallurgy and Materials Science, 38A(12): 2896-2906.
Jiang, F.C. and Vecchio, K.S., 2007b. Experimental investigation of dynamic effects in a two-bar/three-point bend fracture test. Review of Scientific Instruments, 78(6).
Jiang, F.C. and Vecchio, K.S., 2009. Hopkinson Bar Loaded Fracture Experimental Technique: A Critical Review of Dynamic Fracture Toughness Tests. Applied Mechanics Reviews, 62(6): -.
Johnston, C. and Ruiz, C., 1995. Dynamic Testing of Ceramics under Tensile Stress. International Journal of Solids and Structures, 32(17-18): 2647-2656.
Kalthoff, J.F., 1985. On the measurement of dynamic fracture toughnesses - a review of recent work. International Journal of Fracture, 27(3-4): 277-298.
Kaya, A.C. and Erdogan, F., 1980. Stress Intensity Factors and Cod in an Orthotropic Strip. International Journal of Fracture, 16(2): 171-190.
Ke, C.C., Chen, C.S. and Tu, C.H., 2008. Determination of fracture toughness of anisotropic rocks by boundary element method. Rock Mechanics and Rock Engineering, 41(4): 509-538.
Kirby, G.C. and Mazur, C.J., 1985. Fracture toughness testing of coal. In:Proceedings of the 26th US Rock Mechanics Symposium, Rapid City SD. Rotterdam: Balkema: 497-504.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 219
Klepaczko, J.R., 1979. Application of the split Hopkinson pressure bar to fracture dynamic. Mechanical Properties at High Rates of Strain, J. Harding,ed. The Institute of Physics, Bristol, London: 201-214.
Kolsky, H., 1949. An investigation of the mechanical properties of materials at very high rates of loading. Proceedings of the Royal Society A-Mathematical Physical and Engineering Sciences, B62: 676-700.
Kolsky, H., 1953. Stress waves in solids. Clarendon Press, Oxford, 212 pp.
Kuruppu, M.D., 1997. Fracture toughness measurement using chevron notched semi-circular bend specimen. International Journal of Fracture, 86(4): L33-L38.
Lajtai, E.Z., 1972. Effect of tensile stress gradient on brittle-fracture initiation. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 9(5): 569-578.
Lambert, D.E. and Ross, C.A., 2000. Strain rate effects on dynamic fracture and strength. International Journal of Impact Engineering, 24(10): 985-998.
Launeau, P. and Robin, P.Y.F., 1996. Fabric analysis using the intercept method. Tectonophysics, 267(1-4): 91-119.
Lekhnitskii, S.G., 1963. Theory of elasticity of an anisotropic body. Applied mathematics and mechanics. Holden-Day, Inc., San Francisco.
Li, H.B., Zhao, J. and Li, T.J., 1999. Triaxial compression tests on a granite at different strain rates and confining pressures. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 36(8): 1057-1063.
Li, X.B., Lok, T.S., Zhao, J. and Zhao, P.J., 2000. Oscillation elimination in the Hopkinson bar apparatus and resultant complete dynamic stress-strain curves for rocks. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 37(7): 1055-1060.
Li, Y. and Ramesh, K.T., 2007. An optical technique for measurement of material properties in the tension Kolsky bar. International Journal of Impact Engineering, 34: 784-798.
Libatskii, L.L. and Kovchik, S.E., 1967. Fracture of discs containing cracks. Fiziko-Khimicheskaya Mekhanika Materialov, 3: 334-339.
Lim, I.L., Johnston, I.W. and Choi, S.K., 1993. Stress Intensity Factors for Semicircular Specimens under 3-Point Bending. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 44(3): 363-382.
Lim, I.L., Johnston, I.W. and Choi, S.K., 1994a. Assessment of Mixed-Mode Fracture-Toughness Testing Methods for Rock. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 31(3): 265-272.
Lim, I.L., Johnston, I.W., Choi, S.K. and Boland, J.N., 1994b. Fracture Testing of a Soft Rock with Semicircular Specimens under 3-Point Bending .1. Mode-I. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 31(3): 185-197.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 220
Lim, I.L., Johnston, I.W., Choi, S.K. and Boland, J.N., 1994c. Fracture Testing of a Soft Rock with Semicircular Specimens under 3-Point Bending .2. Mixed-Mode. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 31(3): 199-212.
Lindholm, U.S., Yeakley, L.M. and Nagy, A., 1974. Dynamic strength and fracture properties of Dresser basalt. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 11(5): 181-191.
Lorriot, T., Martin, E., Quenisset, J.M. and Rebiere, J.P., 1998. Dynamic analysis of instrumented CHARPY impact tests using specimen deflection measurement and mass-spring models. International Journal of Fracture, 91(4): 299-309.
Marur, P.R., 2000. Dynamic analysis of one-point bend impact test. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 67(1): 41-53.
Masuda, K., Mizutani, H. and Yamada, I., 1987. Experimental Study of Strain-Rate Dependence and Pressure-Dependence of Failure Properties of Granite. Journal of Physics of the Earth, 35(1): 37-66.
Mclamore, R. and Gray, K.E., 1967. Mechanical behavior of anisotropic sedimentary rocks. Journal of Engineering for Industry, 89(1): 62-67.
Meguid, S.A., Gaultier, P.E. and Gong, S.X., 1991. A Comparison between Analytical and Finite-Element Analysis of Main Crack-Microcrack Interaction. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 38(6): 451-465.
Mellor, M. and Hawkes, I., 1971. Measurement of tensile strength by diametral compression of discs and annuli. Engineering Geology, 5: 173-225.
Michell, J.H., 1900. Some elementary distributions of stress in three dimensions. Proceedings of the London Mathematical Society, 32: 23-61.
Mines, R.A.W. and Ruiz, C., 1985. The Dynamic Behavior of the Instrumented Charpy-Test. Journal De Physique, 46(NC-5): 187-196.
Mohanty B., 1987. Strength of rock under high strain loading conditions applicable to blasting, 2nd international symposium on rock Fragmentation by Blasting, Keystone CO, USA. pp. 72-79
Murakami, Y., 1976. A simple procedure for the accurate determination of stress intensity factors by finite element method Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 8: 643-655.
Muskhelishvili, N.I., 1953. Some Basic Problems of the Mathematical Theory of Elasticity. Noordhoff, Groningen, Holland, 704 pp.
Nakano, M., Kishida, K. and Watanabe, Y., 1992. Mixed-Mode Impact Fracture Tests Using Center-Notched Disk Specimens. Proceedings of the International Symposium on Impact Engineering, 2: 581-586.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 221
Nasseri, M.H.B. and Mohanty, B., 2008. Fracture toughness anisotropy in granitic rocks. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 45(2): 167-193.
Nasseri, M.H.B., Mohanty, B. and Robin, P.Y.F., 2005. Characterization of microstructures and fracture toughness in five granitic rocks. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 42(3): 450-460.
Nasseri, M.H.B., Mohanty, B. and Young, R.P., 2006. Fracture toughness measurements and acoustic emission activity in brittle rocks. Pure and Applied Geophysics, 163(5-6): 917-945.
Nasseri, M.H.B., Schubnel, A. and Young, R.P., 2007. Coupled evolutions of fracture toughness and elastic wave velocities at high crack density in thermally treated Westerly granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 44(4): 601-616.
Nemat-Nasser, S., Isaacs, J. and Rome, J., 2000. Triaxial Hopkinson techniques, Mechanical Testing and Evaluatin. ASM Handbook. ASM Int, Materials Park, OH, pp. 1163-1168.
Nemat-Nasser, S., Isaacs, J.B. and Starrett, J.E., 1991. Hopkinson techniques for dynamic recovery experiments. Proceedings of the Royal Society A-Mathematical Physical and Engineering Sciences, 435: 371-391.
Ninan, L., Tsai, J. and Sun, C.T., 2001. Use of split Hopkinson pressure bar for testing off-axis composites. International Journal of Impact Engineering, 25(3): 291-313.
Nwosu, S.N., Hui, D. and Dutta, P.K., 2003. Dynamic mode II delamination fracture of unidirectional graphite/epoxy composites. Composites Part B-Engineering, 34(3): 303-316.
Ogawa, K. and Higashida, F., 1990. Impact Three-Point Bending Tests by Applying Ramped Incident Wave. Reinforced Plastics, 36: 123-129 (in Japanese).
Ortiz, M., 1987. A Continuum Theory of Crack Shielding in Ceramics. Journal of Applied Mechanics-Transactions of the Asme, 54(1): 54-58.
Osborne F.F., 1935. Rift, grain, and hardway in some pre-Cambrian granites, Quebec. Economic Geology, 30(5): 540-551.
Ouchterlony, F., 1987. A presentation of the ISRM suggested methods for determining fracture toughness of rock materials., Proc. 6th Int. Congr. Rock Mechanics, Balkema, Rotterdam, pp. 1181-1186.
Ouchterlony, F., 1988. Suggested methods for determining the fracture toughness of rock. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 25(2): 71-96.
Ouchterlony, F., 1989. On the background to the formulas and accuracy of rock fracture toughness measurements using ISRM standard core specimens. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 26(1): 13-23.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 222
Owen, D.M., Zhuang, S., Rosakis, A.J. and Ravichandran, G., 1998. Experimental determination of dynamic crack initiation and propagation fracture toughness in thin aluminum sheets. International Journal of Fracture, 90(1-2): 153-174.
Peng, S. and Johnson, A.M., 1972. Crack growth and faulting in cylindrical specimens of chelmsford granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 9(1): 37-86.
Phillips, W.J. and Phillips, N., 1980. An introduction to mineralogy for geologists. John Wiley & Sons Inc. , New York.
Ramesh, K.T. and Kelkar, N., 1995. Technique for the continuous measurement of projectile velocities in plate impact experiments. Review of Scientific Instruments, 66(4): 3034-3036.
Ramesh, K.T. and Narasimhan, S., 1996. Finite deformations and the dynamic measurement of radial strains in compression Kolsky bar experiments. International Journal of Solids and Structures, 33(25): 3723-3738.
Ravichandran, G. and Subhash, G., 1994. Critical-appraisal of limiting strain rates for compression testing of ceramics in a split Hopkinson pressure bar. Journal of the American Ceramic Society, 77(1): 263-267.
Rawling, G.C., Baud, P. and Wong, T.F., 2002. Dilatancy, brittle strength, and anisotropy of foliated rocks: Experimental deformation and micromechanical modeling. Journal of Geophysical Research-Solid Earth, 107(B10): -.
Riley, D.K. and Brace, W.F., 1971. Uniaxial Strain Behavior of Fifteen Rocks to 30 Kb. Transactions-American Geophysical Union, 52(4): 346-&.
Rittel, D. and Maigre, H., 1996. An investigation of dynamic crack initiation in PMMA. Mechanics of Materials, 23(3): 229-239.
Rittel, D., Maigre, H. and Bui, H.D., 1992. A New Method for Dynamic Fracture-Toughness Testing. Scripta Metallurgica Et Materialia, 26(10): 1593-1598.
Rizal, S. and Homma, H., 2000. Dimple fracture under short pulse loading. International Journal of Impact Engineering, 24(1): 69-83.
Rodriguez, J., Navarro, C. and Sanchezgalvez, V., 1994. Splitting Tests: an Alternative to Determine the Dynamic Tensile Strength of Ceramic Materials. Journal De Physique Iv, 4(C8): 101-106.
Rooke, D.P. and Tweed, J., 1973. Stress intensity factor of an edge crack in a finite rotating elastic disk. International Journal of Engineering Science, 11(2): 279-283.
Rose, L.R.F., 1986. Microcrack Interaction with a Main Crack. International Journal of Fracture, 31(3): 233-242.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 223
Ross, C.A., Jerome, D.M., Tedesco, J.W. and Hughes, M.L., 1996. Moisture and strain rate effects on concrete strength. Aci Materials Journal, 93(3): 293-300.
Ross, C.A., Tedesco, J.W. and Kuennen, S.T., 1995. Effects of Strain-Rate on Concrete Strength. ACI Materials Journal, 92(1): 37-47.
Ross, C.A., Thompson, P.Y. and Tedesco, J.W., 1989. Split-Hopkinson pressure bar tests on concrete and mortar in tension and compression. ACI Materials Journal, 86(5): 475-481.
Sangha, C.M. and Dhir, R.K., 1975. Strength and Deformation of Rock Subject to Multiaxial Compressive Stresses. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 12(9): 277-282.
Sano, O., Kudo, Y. and Mizuta, Y., 1992. Experimental determination of elastic constants of Oshima granite, Barre granite, and Chelmsford granite. Journal of Geophysical Research-Solid Earth, 97(B3): 3367-3379.
Schedl, A., Kronenberg, A.K. and Tullis, J., 1986. Deformation microstructures of Barre granite: an optical, SEM and TEM study. Tectonophysics, 122(1-2): 149-164.
Shan, R.L., Jiang, Y.S. and Li, B.Q., 2000. Obtaining dynamic complete stress-strain curves for rock using the Split Hopkinson Pressure Bar technique. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 37(6): 983-992.
Shetty, D.K., Rosenfield, A.R. and Duckworth, W.H., 1985. Fracture toughness of ceramics measured by a chevron notch diametral compression test. Journal of the American Ceramic Society, 68(12): C325-C327.
Shiryaev, A.M. and Kotkis, A.M., 1982. Methods for Determining Fracture-Toughness of Brittle Porous Materials. Industrial Laboratory, 48(9): 917-918.
Song, B. and Chen, W., 2004. Loading and unloading split Hopkinson pressure bar pulse-shaping techniques for dynamic hysteretic loops. Experimental Mechanics, 44(6): 622-627.
Song, B. and Chen, W., 2006. Energy for specimen deformation in a split Hopkinson pressure bar experiment. Experimental Mechanics, 46(3): 407-410.
Stroppe, H., Schreppel, U. and Clos, R., 1978. Proceeding of The Seventh Conference of Materials Testing, Budapest: 329.
Sun, Z. and Ouchterlony, F., 1986. Fracture toughness of Stripa granite cores. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences & Geomechanics Abstracts, 23(6): 399-409.
Suresh, S., Ewart, L., Maden, M., Slaughter, W.S. and Nguyen, M., 1987. Fracture toughness measurements in ceramics-pre-cracking in cyclic compression. Journal of Materials Science, 22(4): 1271-1276.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 224
Swan, G. and Alm, O., 1982. Sub-critical crack growth in Stripa granite: Direct observations., Proc. 23rd. U. S. Symp. Rock Mech., University of California, Berkeley, pp. 542-550.
Takemura, T., Golshani, A., Oda, M. and Suzuki, K., 2003. Preferred orientations of open microcracks in granite and their relation with anisotropic elasticity. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 40(4): 443-454.
Tan, C.L. and Gao, Y.L., 1992. Boundary Integral-Equation Fracture-Mechanics Analysis of Plane Orthotropic Bodies. International Journal of Fracture, 53(4): 343-365.
Tanaka, K. and Kagatsume, T., 1980. Impact bending test on steel at low-temperatures using a split Hopkinson bar. Bulletin of the Jsme-Japan Society of Mechanical Engineers, 23(185): 1736-1744.
Tang, C.N. and Xu, X.H., 1990. A new method for measuring dynamic fracture toughness of rock. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 35(4-5): 783-789.
Tedesco, J.W., Hughes, M.L. and Ross, C.A., 1994. Numerical Simulation of High Strain Rate Concrete Compression Tests. Computers & Structures, 51(1): 65-77.
Tedesco, J.W. and Ross, C.A., 1998. Strain rate dependent constitutive equations for concrete. Journal of Pressure Vessel Technology-Transactions of the Asme, 120(4): 398-405.
Tedesco, J.W., Ross, C.A. and Brunair, R.M., 1989. Numerical Analysis of Dynamic Split Cylinder Tests. Computers & Structures, 32(3-4): 609-624.
Tedesco, J.W., Ross, C.A., Mcgill, P.B. and Oneil, B.P., 1991. Numerical Analysis of High-Strain Rate Concrete Direct Tension Tests. Computers & Structures, 40(2): 313-327.
Togami, T.C., Baker, W.E. and Forrestal, M.J., 1996. A split Hopkinson bar technique to evaluate the performance of accelerometers. Journal of Applied Mechanics-Transactions of the Asme, 63(2): 353-356.
Van de Steen, B. and Vervoort, A., 2001. Non-local stress approach to fracture initiation in laboratory experiments with a tensile stress gradient. Mechanics of Materials, 33(12): 729-740.
Vogler, U.W. and Kovari, K., 1978. Suggested Methods for Determining Strength of Rock Materials in Triaxial Compression. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 15(2): 47-51.
Wada, H., 1992. Determination of Dynamic Fracture-Toughness for Pmma. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 41(6): 821-831.
Wai, R.S.C., Lo, K.Y. and Rowe, R.K., 1982. Thermal-Stress Analysis in Rocks with Non-Linear Properties. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 19(5): 211-220.
Wang, Q.Z., Jia, X.M., Kou, S.Q., Zhang, Z.X. and Lindqvist, P.A., 2003. More accurate stress intensity factor derived by finite element analysis for the ISRM suggested rock fracture
BIBLIOGRAPHY 225
toughness specimen - CCNBD. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 40(2): 233-241.
Wang, Q.Z., Li, W. and Song, X.L., 2006. A method for testing dynamic tensile strength and elastic modulus of rock materials using SHPB. Pure and Applied Geophysics, 163: 1091–1100.
Wang, Q.Z., Li, W. and Xie, H.P., 2009. Dynamic split tensile test of Flattened Brazilian Disc of rock with SHPB setup. Mechanics of Materials, 41(3): 252-260.
Wang, Q.Z., Zhang, S. and Xie, H.P., 2010. Rock Dynamic Fracture Toughness Tested with Holed-Cracked Flattened Brazilian Discs Diametrically Impacted by SHPB and its Size Effect. Experimental Mechanics: DOI 10.1007/s11340-009-9265-2.
Weerasooriya, T., Moy, P., Casem, D., Cheng, M. and Chen, W., 2006. A four-point bend technique to determine dynamic fracture toughness of ceramics. Journal of the American Ceramic Society, 89(3): 990-995.
Weisbrod, G. and Rittel, D., 2000. A method for dynamic fracture toughness determination using short beams. International Journal of Fracture, 104(1): 89-103.
Wright, P.W. and Lyon, R.J., 1959. Proce. conf. on properties of materials at high rates of strain, London, pp. 37-50.
Wu, M.B., 1986. Effects of loading rates on fracture toughness of rock. Mechanics and Practice, 10(2): 21-23.
Wu, X.J. and Gorham, D.A., 1997. Stress equilibrium in the split Hopkinson pressure bar test. Journal De Physique IV, 7(C3): 91-96.
Xia, K., Chalivendra, V.B. and Rosakis, A.J., 2006. Observing ideal "self-similar" crack growth in experiments. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 73(18): 2748-2755.
Xia, K., Nasseri, M.H.B., Mohanty, B., Lu, F., Chen R. and Luo S.N., 2008. Effects of microstructures on dynamic compression of Barre granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 45(6): 879-887.
Xia, Y.M., Rao, S.G. and Yang, B.C., 1994. A Novel Method for Measuring Plane-Stress Dynamic Fracture-Toughness. Engineering Fracture Mechanics, 48(1): 17-24.
Yang, C.H. and Li, T.J., 1994. The strain rate dependent mechanical properties of marble and its constitutive relation. In: Proceedings of the International Conference on Computational Methods in Structural and Geotechnical Engineering, Hong Kong: 1350-1354.
Yokoyama, T. and Kishida, K., 1989. A Novel Impact 3-Point Bend Test Method for Determining Dynamic Fracture-Initiation Toughness. Experimental Mechanics, 29(2): 188-194.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 226
Zhang, Z.X., Kou, S.Q., Jiang, L.G. and Lindqvist, P.A., 2000. Effects of loading rate on rock fracture: fracture characteristics and energy partitioning. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 37(5): 745-762.
Zhang, Z.X., Kou, S.Q., Yu, J., Yu, Y., Jiang, L.G. and Lindqvist, P.A., 1999. Effects of loading rate on rock fracture. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 36(5): 597-611.
Zhang, Z.X., Yu, J., Kou, S.Q. and Lindqvist, P.A., 2001. Effects of high temperatures on dynamic rock fracture. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 38(2): 211-225.
Zhao, J. and Li, H.B., 2000. Experimental determination of dynamic tensile properties of a granite. International Journal of Rock Mechanics and Mining Sciences, 37(5): 861-866.
Zhou, J., Wang, Y. and Xia, Y.M., 2006. Mode-I fracture toughness of PMMA at high loading rates. Journal of Materials Science, 41(24): 8363-8366.